]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - ld/ld.texi
gas: Reuse the input file entry in the file table
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
b3adc24a 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
b3adc24a 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c
NC
87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88\hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
b3adc24a 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
129@ifset GENERIC
130* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
131@end ifset
132@ifclear GENERIC
133@ifset H8300
134* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
135@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
136@ifset Renesas
137* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 138@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
139@ifset ARM
140* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
141@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
142@ifset M68HC11
143* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
144@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
145@ifset HPPA
146* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
147@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
148@ifset M68K
149* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
150@end ifset
833794fc
MR
151@ifset MIPS
152* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
153@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
154@ifset POWERPC
155* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
156@end ifset
157@ifset POWERPC64
158* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
159@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
160@ifset S/390
161* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
162@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
163@ifset SPU
164* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
165@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
166@ifset TICOFF
167* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
168@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
169@ifset WIN32
170* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
171@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
172@ifset XTENSA
173* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
174@end ifset
252b5132
RH
175@end ifclear
176@ifclear SingleFormat
177* BFD:: BFD
178@end ifclear
179@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
180
181* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
182* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 183* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 184* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 185@end menu
84ec0e6d 186@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
187
188@node Overview
189@chapter Overview
190
191@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
192@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 193
0879a67a 194@ifset man
0285c67d 195@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 196ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
197@c man end
198
199@c man begin SEEALSO
200ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
201the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
202@file{ld}.
203@c man end
204@end ifset
205
206@c man begin DESCRIPTION
207
ff5dcc92 208@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 209their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 210compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 211
ff5dcc92 212@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
213a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
214to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
215
0285c67d
NC
216@ifset man
217@c For the man only
ece2d90e 218This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
219@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
220language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
221@end ifset
222
252b5132 223@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
224This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
225to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
226write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
227@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
228available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
229@end ifclear
230
231Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
232linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
233execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 234@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
235(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
236
0285c67d
NC
237@c man end
238
252b5132
RH
239@node Invocation
240@chapter Invocation
241
0285c67d
NC
242@c man begin DESCRIPTION
243
ff5dcc92 244The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
245and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
246you have many choices to control its behavior.
247
0285c67d
NC
248@c man end
249
252b5132
RH
250@ifset UsesEnvVars
251@menu
a05a5b64 252* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
253* Environment:: Environment Variables
254@end menu
255
256@node Options
a05a5b64 257@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
258@end ifset
259
260@cindex command line
261@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
262
263@c man begin OPTIONS
264
252b5132
RH
265The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
266practice few of them are used in any particular context.
267@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 268For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
269object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
270link a file @code{hello.o}:
271
272@smallexample
273ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
274@end smallexample
275
ff5dcc92 276This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
277result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
278the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
279directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
280
ff5dcc92 281Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
282point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
283as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
284which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
285files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
286different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
287occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
288option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
289noted in the descriptions below.
290
291@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
292Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
293together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
294options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
295an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
296
297Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
298specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
299and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
300are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
301message @samp{No input files}.
302
36f63dca 303If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
304assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
305augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
306linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
307permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
308or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
309@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
310script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
311extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
312to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
313the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
314
315For options whose names are a single letter,
316option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
317whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
318option that requires them.
319
320For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 321precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 322@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 323this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 324only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
325@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
326name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
327output.
328
329Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
330option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
331immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
332@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
333Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
334accepted.
252b5132 335
36f63dca 336Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 337(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
338prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
339compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
340
341@smallexample
2509a395 342 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
343@end smallexample
344
345This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
346silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
347may also arise when passing options that require values through a
348driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
349a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
350and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
351the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
352
353@smallexample
354 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
355@end smallexample
4e53152f 356
a05a5b64 357Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
358linker:
359
ff5dcc92 360@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 361@include at-file.texi
dff70155 362
2509a395
SL
363@kindex -a @var{keyword}
364@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
365This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
366argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
367@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
368@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
369to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
370
7ee314fa
AM
371@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
372@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
374@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
375specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
376will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
377finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 378it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 379This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 380interface.
7ee314fa 381
252b5132
RH
382@ifclear SingleFormat
383@cindex binary input format
384@kindex -b @var{format}
385@kindex --format=@var{format}
386@cindex input format
387@cindex input format
388@item -b @var{input-format}
389@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
390@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
391file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 392@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 393that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 394configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 395to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
396default input format the most usual format on each machine.
397@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
398supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
399formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
400@xref{BFD}.
401
402You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
403binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
404linking object files of different formats), by including
405@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 406particular format.
252b5132
RH
407
408The default format is taken from the environment variable
409@code{GNUTARGET}.
410@ifset UsesEnvVars
411@xref{Environment}.
412@end ifset
413You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
414@code{TARGET};
415@ifclear man
416see @ref{Format Commands}.
417@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
418@end ifclear
419
420@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
421@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@cindex compatibility, MRI
423@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
424@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 425For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 426files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
427@ifclear man
428@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
429@end ifclear
430@ifset man
431the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
432@end ifset
433Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 434the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
435scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
436If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
437specified by any @samp{-L} options.
438
439@cindex common allocation
440@kindex -d
441@kindex -dc
442@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 443@item -d
252b5132
RH
444@itemx -dc
445@itemx -dp
446These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
447compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
448even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
449script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
450@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
451
7ee314fa
AM
452@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
453@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
454@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
455@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
456Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
457@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
458specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
459will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
460option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 461The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 462
abf874aa
CL
463@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
464@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
466fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
467section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
468error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
469several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
470section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
471sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
472
473@smallexample
474 MEMORY @{
475 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
476 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
477 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 @}
479 SECTIONS @{
480 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
481 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
482 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 @}
484
485 with input sections:
486 .data.1: size 8
487 .data.2: size 0x10
488 .data.3: size 4
489
490 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
491 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
492@end smallexample
493
494This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
495the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
496
497@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
498@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499This option enables warnings when
500@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
501matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
502discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
503output region.
504
252b5132
RH
505@cindex entry point, from command line
506@kindex -e @var{entry}
507@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 508@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
509@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
510Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
511program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
512named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
513and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
514base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
515@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
516and other ways of specifying the entry point.
517
b58f81ae
DJ
518@kindex --exclude-libs
519@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
520Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 521exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
522@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
523automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
524port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
525explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
526option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
527be treated as hidden.
528
e1c37eb5
DK
529@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
530@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
531Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
532should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
533into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
534may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
535used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
536the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
537match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
538command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
539of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
540regardless of this option.
541
252b5132
RH
542@cindex dynamic symbol table
543@kindex -E
544@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 545@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
546@item -E
547@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
548@itemx --no-export-dynamic
549When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
550option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
551all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
552set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
553
554If you do not use either of these options (or use the
555@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
556dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
557referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
558
559If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
560back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
561dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
562linking the program itself.
563
55255dae 564You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 565be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 566See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 567
8b747e1a
DK
568Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
569support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
570the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
571
37a141bf
FS
572@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
573@cindex export dynamic symbol
574@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
575When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
576@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
577shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
578bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
579no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
580@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
581on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
582
583@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
584@cindex export dynamic symbol list
585@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
586Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
587The format of the file is the same as the version node without
588scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
589
36f63dca 590@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
591@cindex big-endian objects
592@cindex endianness
593@kindex -EB
594@item -EB
595Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
596
597@cindex little-endian objects
598@kindex -EL
599@item -EL
600Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 601@end ifclear
252b5132 602
2509a395
SL
603@kindex -f @var{name}
604@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
605@item -f @var{name}
606@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
607When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
608to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
609table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
610symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
611
612If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
613run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
614the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
615first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
616@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
617in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
618Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
619implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 620machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
621
622This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
623will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
624
2509a395
SL
625@kindex -F @var{name}
626@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 627@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 628@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
629When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
630the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
631of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
632on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
633
634If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
635run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
636dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
637filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
638found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
639used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
640@var{name}.
641
ff5dcc92 642Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 643toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
644object files.
645@ifclear SingleFormat
646The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 647@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 648@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
649environment variable.
650@end ifclear
651The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
652creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 653
3dbf70a2 654@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
655@kindex -fini=@var{name}
656@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
657When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
658executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
659address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
660the function to call.
661
252b5132
RH
662@kindex -g
663@item -g
664Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
665
2509a395
SL
666@kindex -G @var{value}
667@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 668@cindex object size
2509a395 669@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
670@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
671Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
672@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 673MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
674sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
675
676@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 677@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 678@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 679@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
680@itemx -soname=@var{name}
681When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
682the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
683which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
684linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
685field rather than the using the file name given to the linker.
686
687@kindex -i
688@cindex incremental link
689@item -i
690Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
691
3dbf70a2 692@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
693@kindex -init=@var{name}
694@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
695When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
696executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
697of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
698function to call.
699
252b5132 700@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 701@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 702@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 703@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
704@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
705Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
706list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
707If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 708will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 709will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 710
ff5dcc92 711On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
712files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
713and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
714called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
715@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
716indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
717to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
718@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
719
720The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
721specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
722was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
723command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
724archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
725the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
726
ff5dcc92 727See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
728archives multiple times.
729
730You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
731
732@ifset GENERIC
733This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 734if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
735behaviour of the AIX linker.
736@end ifset
737
738@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 739@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 740@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 741@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 742@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
743Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
744for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
745option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
746in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
747on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 748@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
749order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
750how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
751option is specified.
252b5132 752
3aa2d05a
NC
753If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
754prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
755@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 756
252b5132
RH
757@ifset UsesEnvVars
758The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 759@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
760some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
761@end ifset
762
763The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
764@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
765at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
766
767@cindex emulation
768@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 769@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
770Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
771emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
772
773If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
774@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
775
776Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
777configured.
778
779@cindex link map
780@kindex -M
781@kindex --print-map
782@item -M
783@itemx --print-map
784Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
785information about the link, including the following:
786
787@itemize @bullet
788@item
3b83e13a 789Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
790@item
791How common symbols are allocated.
792@item
793All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
794which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
795@item
796The values assigned to symbols.
797
798Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
799involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
800have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
801linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
802of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
803the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
804linker script containing:
805
806@smallexample
807 foo = 1
808 foo = foo * 4
809 foo = foo + 8
810@end smallexample
811
812will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
813option is used:
814
815@smallexample
816 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
817 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
819@end smallexample
820
821See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
822scripts.
d2ef37eb 823
06ddcada
AM
824@item
825How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 826
06ddcada
AM
827When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
828.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
829These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
830
831@smallexample
832Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
833@end smallexample
834
06ddcada 835This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
836merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
837is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
838
839@smallexample
06ddcada 840Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
841@end smallexample
842
06ddcada 843This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
844when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
845is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
846@end itemize
847
035801ce
FS
848@cindex link map discarded
849@kindex --print-map-discarded
850@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
851@item --print-map-discarded
852@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
853Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
854in the link map. Enabled by default.
855
252b5132
RH
856@kindex -n
857@cindex read-only text
858@cindex NMAGIC
859@kindex --nmagic
860@item -n
861@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
862Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
863libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
864mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
865
866@kindex -N
867@kindex --omagic
868@cindex read/write from cmd line
869@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 870@item -N
252b5132
RH
871@itemx --omagic
872Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
873not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
874libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
875mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
876is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
877specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
878
879@kindex --no-omagic
880@cindex OMAGIC
881@item --no-omagic
882This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
883sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
884be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
885shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
886
887@kindex -o @var{output}
888@kindex --output=@var{output}
889@cindex naming the output file
890@item -o @var{output}
891@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 892Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
893option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
894script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
895
f37b21b4
RM
896@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
897@cindex dependency file
898@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
899Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
900suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
901that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
902output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
903Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
904Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
905to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
906linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
907@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
908installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
909distributed makefiles without careful editing.
910
252b5132
RH
911@kindex -O @var{level}
912@cindex generating optimized output
913@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 914If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 915the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
916should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
917option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
918the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
919no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
920of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 921
387dd777
DP
922@kindex -plugin @var{name}
923@item -plugin @var{name}
924Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
925the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
926automatically added by the complier, when using link time
927optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
928wish.
929
930Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
931from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
932@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
933those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 934copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 935based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 936just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 937
26278bb8
UD
938@kindex --push-state
939@cindex push state governing input file handling
940@item --push-state
941The @option{--push-state} allows to preserve the current state of the
942flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
943restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
944
945The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
946@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
947@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
948@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
949@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
950@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
951
952One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
953used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
954listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
955something as follows:
956
957@smallexample
958-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
959@end smallexample
960
961@kindex --pop-state
962@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 963@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
964Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
965flags governing input file handling.
966
a712da20
NC
967@kindex -q
968@kindex --emit-relocs
969@cindex retain relocations in final executable
970@item -q
971@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 972Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
973Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
974order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
975in larger executables.
976
dbab7a7b
NC
977This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
978
4f471f39
RS
979@kindex --force-dynamic
980@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
981@item --force-dynamic
982Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
983to VxWorks targets.
984
252b5132
RH
985@cindex partial link
986@cindex relocatable output
987@kindex -r
1049f94e 988@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 989@item -r
1049f94e 990@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 991Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 992turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
993linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
994magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
995@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 996@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
997If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
998linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
999constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1000
62bf86b4
HPN
1001When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1002partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1003relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1004example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1005with input files in other formats at all.
1006
252b5132
RH
1007This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1008
1009@kindex -R @var{file}
1010@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1011@cindex symbol-only input
1012@item -R @var{filename}
1013@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1014Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1015relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1016to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1017programs. You may use this option more than once.
1018
ff5dcc92 1019For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1020followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1021the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1022
1023@kindex -s
1024@kindex --strip-all
1025@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1026@item -s
252b5132
RH
1027@itemx --strip-all
1028Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1029
1030@kindex -S
1031@kindex --strip-debug
1032@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1033@item -S
252b5132
RH
1034@itemx --strip-debug
1035Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1036
a70f34c0
NC
1037@kindex --strip-discarded
1038@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1039@item --strip-discarded
1040@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1041Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1042Enabled by default.
1043
252b5132
RH
1044@kindex -t
1045@kindex --trace
1046@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1047@item -t
252b5132 1048@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1049Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1050@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1051@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1052and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1053a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1054
1055@kindex -T @var{script}
1056@kindex --script=@var{script}
1057@cindex script files
1058@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1059@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1060Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
ff5dcc92 1061@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
252b5132 1062@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1063output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1064the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1065specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1066options accumulate.
252b5132 1067
14be8564
L
1068@kindex -dT @var{script}
1069@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1070@cindex script files
1071@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1072@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1073Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1074
1075This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1076processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1077command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1078@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1079behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1080command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1081the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1082@samp{gcc}).
1083
252b5132
RH
1084@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1085@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1086@cindex undefined symbol
1087@item -u @var{symbol}
1088@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1089Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1090symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1091modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1092different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1093option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1094
0a618243
AB
1095If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1096into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1097undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1098instead.
1099
1100@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1101@cindex symbols, require defined
1102@cindex defined symbol
1103@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1104Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1105is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1106is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1107and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1108@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1109can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1110
252b5132
RH
1111@kindex -Ur
1112@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1113@item -Ur
252b5132
RH
1114For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1115@samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1116turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
252b5132
RH
1117@emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1118It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1119with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1120be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1121@samp{-r} for the others.
1122
c005eb9e
AB
1123@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1124@cindex orphan sections
1125@cindex sections, orphan
1126@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1127Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1128specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1129
1130@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1131
1132@table @code
1133@item place
1134Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1135the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1136@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1137
1138@item discard
1139All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1140@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1141
1142@item warn
1143The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1144issue a warning.
1145
1146@item error
1147The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1148@end table
1149
1150The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1151
577a0623
AM
1152@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1153@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1155@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1156missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1157specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1158multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1159input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1160in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1161
252b5132
RH
1162@kindex -v
1163@kindex -V
1164@kindex --version
1165@cindex version
1166@item -v
1167@itemx --version
1168@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1169Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
252b5132
RH
1170lists the supported emulations.
1171
1172@kindex -x
1173@kindex --discard-all
1174@cindex deleting local symbols
1175@item -x
1176@itemx --discard-all
1177Delete all local symbols.
1178
1179@kindex -X
1180@kindex --discard-locals
1181@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1182@item -X
252b5132 1183@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1184Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1185system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1186or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1187
1188@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1189@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1190@cindex symbol tracing
1191@item -y @var{symbol}
1192@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1193Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1194option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1195to prepend an underscore.
1196
1197This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1198don't know where the reference is coming from.
1199
1200@kindex -Y @var{path}
1201@item -Y @var{path}
1202Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1203for Solaris compatibility.
1204
1205@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1206@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1207The recognized keywords are:
1208@table @samp
1209
e6e2dfbd
AM
1210@item bndplt
1211Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1212
1213@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1214@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1215@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1216@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1217Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1218to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1219@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1220@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1221@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1222@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1223Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1224
233a0083
L
1225@item cet-report=none
1226@itemx cet-report=warning
1227@itemx cet-report=error
1228Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1229GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1230section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1231linker not report missing properties in input files.
1232@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1233missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1234the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1235Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1236GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1237turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1238Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1239
cd6d6c15 1240@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1241@itemx nocombreloc
1242Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1243dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1244
b8871f35 1245@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1246@itemx nocommon
1247Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1248link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1249
1250@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1251Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1252layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1253using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1254
cd6d6c15 1255@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1256Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1257is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1258This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1259
e6e2dfbd
AM
1260@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1261@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1262Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1263if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1264by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1265@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1266may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1267selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1268these options.
1269
6aa29e7b
JJ
1270@item execstack
1271Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1272
b039ef04
L
1273@item global
1274This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1275the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1276of subsequently loaded libraries.
1277
93ab9c0d
NC
1278@item globalaudit
1279This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1280This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1281setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1282tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1283the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1284all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1285
e6e2dfbd
AM
1286@item ibtplt
1287Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1288Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1289
8df93cb5 1290@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1291Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1292to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1293Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1294
cd6d6c15
NC
1295@item initfirst
1296This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1297It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1298before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1299the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1300the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1301objects.
1302
1303@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1304Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1305so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1306libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1307
5fa222e4
AM
1308@item lazy
1309When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1310dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1311the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1312Lazy binding is the default.
1313
cd6d6c15 1314@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1315Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1316
e6e2dfbd
AM
1317@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1318Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1319
e6e2dfbd
AM
1320@item muldefs
1321Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1322
cd6d6c15 1323@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1324Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1325defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1326
1327@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1328Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1329should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1330
1331@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1332Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1333
1334@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1335Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1336
1337@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1338Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1339
6aa29e7b
JJ
1340@item noexecstack
1341Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1342
e6e2dfbd
AM
1343@item noextern-protected-data
1344Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1345library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1346used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1347generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1348module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1349i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1350
e6e2dfbd
AM
1351@item noreloc-overflow
1352Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1353relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1354overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1355
cd6d6c15
NC
1356@item now
1357When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1358dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1359when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1360function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1361called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1362
1363@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1364Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1365
6aa29e7b 1366@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1367@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1368Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1369specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1370relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1371than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1372Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1373
47acac12
L
1374@item separate-code
1375@itemx noseparate-code
1376Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1377specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1378be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1379code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1380
496afd17
L
1381@item unique-symbol
1382@itemx nounique-symbol
1383Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1384".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1385is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1386
e6e2dfbd
AM
1387@item shstk
1388Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1389to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1390Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1391
04c3a755 1392@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1393Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1394Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1395@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1396
cae64165
RM
1397@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1398@cindex visibility
1399@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1400Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1401@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1402Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1403@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1404start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1405compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1406recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1407programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1408between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1409
e6e2dfbd
AM
1410@item text
1411@itemx notext
1412@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1413Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1414or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1415report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1416
97a232d7
NC
1417@item undefs
1418Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1419either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1420This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1421
32930e4e
L
1422@item x86-64-v2
1423@item x86-64-v3
1424@itemx x86-64-v4
1425Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
1426@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1427@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1428@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1429Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1430
cd6d6c15
NC
1431@end table
1432
ece2d90e 1433Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1434
1435@kindex -(
1436@cindex groups of archives
1437@item -( @var{archives} -)
1438@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1439The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1440either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1441
1442The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1443references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1444the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1445archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1446object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1447would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1448they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1449resolved.
1450
1451Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1452it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1453more archives.
1454
69da35b5
NC
1455@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1456@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1457@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1458@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1459Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1460recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1461and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1462the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1463behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1464so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1465restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1466
4a43e768
AM
1467@kindex --as-needed
1468@kindex --no-as-needed
1469@item --as-needed
1470@itemx --no-as-needed
1471This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1472on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1473the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1474on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1475needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1476emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1477non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1478the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1479non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1480Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1481the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1482needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1483from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1484
e56f61be
L
1485@kindex --add-needed
1486@kindex --no-add-needed
1487@item --add-needed
1488@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1489These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1490their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1491options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1492and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1493
252b5132
RH
1494@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1495@item -assert @var{keyword}
1496This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1497
1498@kindex -Bdynamic
1499@kindex -dy
1500@kindex -call_shared
1501@item -Bdynamic
1502@itemx -dy
1503@itemx -call_shared
1504Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1505for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1506default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1507for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1508multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1509@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1510
a1ab1d2a
UD
1511@kindex -Bgroup
1512@item -Bgroup
1513Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1514section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1515object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1516@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1517only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1518
252b5132
RH
1519@kindex -Bstatic
1520@kindex -dn
1521@kindex -non_shared
1522@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1523@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1524@itemx -dn
1525@itemx -non_shared
1526@itemx -static
1527Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1528platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1529variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1530may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1531library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1532option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1533option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1534shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1535references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1536libraries.
252b5132
RH
1537
1538@kindex -Bsymbolic
1539@item -Bsymbolic
1540When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1541definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1542for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1543within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1544platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1545
40b36307
L
1546@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1547@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1548When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1549symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1550This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1551libraries.
40b36307 1552
55255dae
L
1553@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1554@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1555Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1556typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1557global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1558within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1559to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1560in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1561which support shared libraries.
1562
1563The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1564scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1565
40b36307
L
1566@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1567@item --dynamic-list-data
1568Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1569
1570@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1571@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1572Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1573is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1574
0b8a70d9
L
1575@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1576@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1577Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1578
252b5132
RH
1579@kindex --check-sections
1580@kindex --no-check-sections
1581@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1582@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1583Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1584been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1585perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1586suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1587allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1588restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1589Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1590force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1591option.
252b5132 1592
ddbb8a31
NC
1593@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1594@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1595@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1596@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1597This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1598by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1599command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1600output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1601input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1602specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1603follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1604behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1605
1606This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1607libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1608mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1609their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1610required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1611the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1612dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1613symbols.
1614
252b5132
RH
1615@cindex cross reference table
1616@kindex --cref
1617@item --cref
1618Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1619generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1620Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1621
1622The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1623easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1624sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1625symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1626definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1627where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1628symbol are listed.
252b5132 1629
5dba6f05
NA
1630@cindex ctf variables
1631@kindex --ctf-variables
1632@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1633@item --ctf-variables
1634@item --no-ctf-variables
1635The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1636types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1637table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1638conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1639usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1640@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1641The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1642
1643@cindex ctf type sharing
1644@kindex --ctf-share-types
1645@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1646Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1647
1648@table @samp
1649@item share-unconflicted
1650Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1651where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1652translation unit. This is the default.
1653
1654@item share-duplicated
1655Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1656dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1657dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1658always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1659larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1660large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1661consumer at runtime.
1662@end table
1663
4818e05f
AM
1664@cindex common allocation
1665@kindex --no-define-common
1666@item --no-define-common
1667This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1668The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1669@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1670
1671The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1672the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1673of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1674forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1675Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1676from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1677This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1678and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1679duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1680paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1681
7bdf4127
AB
1682@cindex group allocation in linker script
1683@cindex section groups
1684@cindex COMDAT
1685@kindex --force-group-allocation
1686@item --force-group-allocation
1687This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1688normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1689default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1690change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1691command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1692effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1693
252b5132 1694@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1695@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1696@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1697Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1698address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1699times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1700limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1701context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1702symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1703constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1704using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1705@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1706equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132
RH
1707
1708@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1709@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1710@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1711@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1712@itemx --no-demangle
1713These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1714and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1715present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1716underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1717mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1718different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1719to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1720demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1721is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1722
1723@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1724@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1725@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1726@item -I@var{file}
1727@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1728Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1729generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1730linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1731doing.
1732
9b8b325a
RF
1733@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1734@item --no-dynamic-linker
1735When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1736linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1737executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1738entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1739
a70f34c0
NC
1740@kindex --embedded-relocs
1741@item --embedded-relocs
1742This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1743that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1744is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1745targets.
1746
3f0a5f17
ME
1747@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1748@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1749Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1750in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1751
7ce691ae 1752@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1753@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1754@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1755@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1756Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1757with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1758
252b5132
RH
1759@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1760@item --force-exe-suffix
1761Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1762
1763If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1764@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1765the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1766option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1767Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1768it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1769
1770@kindex --gc-sections
1771@kindex --no-gc-sections
1772@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
1773@item --gc-sections
1774@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 1775Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 1776targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 1777performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
1778@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1779collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1780implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 1781
d5465ba2
AM
1782@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1783examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1784symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1785command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1786referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1787libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1788referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1789the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
1790relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1791@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 1792
ac69cbc6 1793This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 1794@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
1795specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1796@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1797command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 1798
c17d87de
NC
1799@kindex --print-gc-sections
1800@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1801@cindex garbage collection
1802@item --print-gc-sections
1803@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1804List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1805printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1806collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1807default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1808be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1809line.
1810
22185505 1811@kindex --gc-keep-exported
1812@cindex garbage collection
1813@item --gc-keep-exported
1814When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1815collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1816default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1817executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1818collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1819Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1820it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1821ELF format targets.
1822
30824704
RM
1823@kindex --print-output-format
1824@cindex output format
1825@item --print-output-format
1826Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1827other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1828in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1829
3604cb1f
TG
1830@kindex --print-memory-usage
1831@cindex memory usage
1832@item --print-memory-usage
1833Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1834the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1835quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1836headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1837parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1838
1839@smallexample
1840Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1841 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1842 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1843@end smallexample
1844
252b5132
RH
1845@cindex help
1846@cindex usage
1847@kindex --help
1848@item --help
1849Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1850
ea20a7da
CC
1851@kindex --target-help
1852@item --target-help
a094d01f 1853Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 1854
2509a395
SL
1855@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1856@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 1857Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
72a3b182
NC
1858@option{-M} option, above. Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile}
1859causes the linker map to be written into a file inside the directory.
1860The name of the file is based upon the @var{output} filename with
1861@code{.map} appended.
252b5132
RH
1862
1863@cindex memory usage
1864@kindex --no-keep-memory
1865@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
1866@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
1867symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 1868instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 1869necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
1870while linking a large executable.
1871
1872@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1873@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 1874@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 1875@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1876@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
1877Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1878is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1879The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
1880behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 1881libraries being linked in.
252b5132 1882
97a232d7
NC
1883The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
1884
aa713662
L
1885@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
1886@kindex -z muldefs
1887@item --allow-multiple-definition
1888@itemx -z muldefs
1889Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
1890report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
1891first definition will be used.
1892
b79e8c78 1893@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 1894@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 1895@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 1896@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 1897Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
1898This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
1899determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
1900shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
1901how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
1902
903249d7
NC
1903The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
1904referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
1905an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
1906a shared library.
1907
1908The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
1909libraries specified at link time are that:
1910
1911@itemize @bullet
1912@item
1913A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
1914that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
1915resolvable at load time.
1916@item
1917There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
1918symbols in shared libraries are normal.
1919
1920The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
1921select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
1922architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
1923appropriate memset function.
1924@end itemize
b79e8c78 1925
23ae20f5
NC
1926@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
1927@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
1928If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
1929@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
1930only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
1931libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
1932``missing-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
1933missing symbol or library. The intention is that the script will
1934provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
1935might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
1936error message will be displayed.
1937
1938The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
1939switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
1940
31941635
L
1941@kindex --no-undefined-version
1942@item --no-undefined-version
1943Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
1944it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
1945will be issued instead.
1946
3e3b46e5
PB
1947@kindex --default-symver
1948@item --default-symver
1949Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
1950exported symbols.
1951
1952@kindex --default-imported-symver
1953@item --default-imported-symver
1954Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
1955imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 1956
252b5132
RH
1957@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
1958@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 1959Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
1960files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
1961been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 1962This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
1963errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
1964have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
1965inappropriate.
1966
fe7929ce
AM
1967@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
1968@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
1969Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
1970library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
1971
252b5132
RH
1972@kindex --no-whole-archive
1973@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 1974Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
1975archive files.
1976
1977@cindex output file after errors
1978@kindex --noinhibit-exec
1979@item --noinhibit-exec
1980Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
1981Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
1982errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
1983when it issues any error whatsoever.
1984
0a9c1c8e
CD
1985@kindex -nostdlib
1986@item -nostdlib
1987Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
1988command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
1989(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
1990
252b5132 1991@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
1992@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
1993@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
1994@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
1995file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 1996@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
1997object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
1998object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
1999should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2000usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2001name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2002list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2003command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2004this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2005@end ifclear
2006
76359541
TP
2007@kindex --out-implib
2008@item --out-implib @var{file}
2009Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2010the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2011library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2012may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2013behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2014step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2015the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2016
36af4a4e
JJ
2017@kindex -pie
2018@kindex --pic-executable
2019@item -pie
2020@itemx --pic-executable
2021@cindex position independent executables
2022Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2023ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2024libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 2025address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
2026normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2027defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2028
252b5132
RH
2029@kindex -qmagic
2030@item -qmagic
2031This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2032
2033@kindex -Qy
2034@item -Qy
2035This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2036
2037@kindex --relax
2038@cindex synthesizing linker
2039@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2040@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2041@item --relax
28d5f677 2042@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2043An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2044@ifset GENERIC
2045This option is only supported on a few targets.
2046@end ifset
2047@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2048@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2049@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2050@ifset XTENSA
2051@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2052@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2053@ifset M68HC11
2054@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2055@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2056@ifset NIOSII
2057@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2058@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2059@ifset POWERPC
2060@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2061@end ifset
252b5132 2062
ccd9fae5 2063On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2064global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2065addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2066synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2067instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2068
2069On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2070debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2071@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2072This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2073family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2074@end ifset
2075
ccd9fae5
NC
2076On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2077@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2078
ccd9fae5
NC
2079On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2080and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2081
252b5132
RH
2082@cindex retaining specified symbols
2083@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2084@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2085@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2086@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2087Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2088discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2089symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2090@ifset GENERIC
2091(such as VxWorks)
2092@end ifset
2093where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2094run-time memory.
2095
2096@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2097or symbols needed for relocations.
2098
2099You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2100line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2101
2102@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2103@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2104@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2105@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2106Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2107linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2108arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2109them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2110
2111The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2112are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2113description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2114in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2115have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2116
2117If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2118contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2119is defined.
252b5132 2120
ff5dcc92 2121The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2122SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2123@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2124runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2125options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2126gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2127file systems.
252b5132 2128
ff5dcc92 2129For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2130followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2131the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2132@end ifset
2133
2134@ifset GENERIC
2135@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2136@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2137@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2138When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2139happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2140of the input files.
2141
2142When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2143non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2144shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2145explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2146specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2147@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2148either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2149appearing multiple times.
2150
e680a6b6
NC
2151The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2152directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2153containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2154and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
215564-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2156
2157The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2158@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2159supported.
2160
28c309a2
NC
2161This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2162that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2163is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2164runtime linker would do.
2165
252b5132 2166The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2167libraries:
d8e4137b 2168
252b5132
RH
2169@enumerate
2170@item
ff5dcc92 2171Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2172@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2173Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2174between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2175specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2176used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2177at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2178by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2179the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2180@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2181On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2182@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2183environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2184@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2185On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2186directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2187@item
a1b8d843 2188For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2189variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2190@item
ec4eb78a
L
2191For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2192@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2193libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2194@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2195@item
252b5132
RH
2196The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2197@item
d8e4137b
NC
2198For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2199exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2200to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2201defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2202configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2203@item
2204For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2205the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2206header file.
2207@item
2208Any directories specifed by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in the
2209linker script being used.
252b5132
RH
2210@end enumerate
2211
2212If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2213warning and continue with the link.
2214@end ifset
2215
2216@kindex -shared
2217@kindex -Bshareable
2218@item -shared
2219@itemx -Bshareable
2220@cindex shared libraries
2221Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2222and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2223shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2224undefined symbols in the link.
2225
252b5132 2226@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2227@item --sort-common
2228@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2229@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2230This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2231ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2232sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2233eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2234between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2235specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2236
2509a395
SL
2237@kindex --sort-section=name
2238@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2239This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2240patterns in the linker script.
2241
2509a395
SL
2242@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2243@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2244This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2245patterns in the linker script.
2246
a70f34c0
NC
2247@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2248@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2249This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2250.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2251post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2252
252b5132 2253@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2254@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2255Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2256each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2257size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2258
2259@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2260@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2261Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2262output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2263This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2264certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2265cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2266that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2267support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2268input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2269more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2270many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2271
2272@kindex --stats
2273@item --stats
2274Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2275as execution time and memory usage.
2276
2509a395 2277@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2278@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2279Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2280configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2281that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2282
a70f34c0
NC
2283@kindex --task-link
2284@item --task-link
2285This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2286file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2287
252b5132
RH
2288@kindex --traditional-format
2289@cindex traditional format
2290@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2291For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2292the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2293use the traditional format instead.
2294
2295@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2296For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2297symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2298full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2299@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2300trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2301combine duplicate entries.
2302
2509a395
SL
2303@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2304@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2305Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2306address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2307times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2308line.
2309@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2310for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2311@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2312should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2313sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2314
2509a395
SL
2315@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2316@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2317@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2318@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2319@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2320@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2321@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2322Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2323@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2324
2509a395
SL
2325@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2326@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2327@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2328When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2329byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2330
9d5777a3
RM
2331@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2332@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2333@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2334When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2335the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2336text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2337
0d705e9f
AM
2338@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2339@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2340@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2341When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2342model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2343
560e09e9
NC
2344@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2345@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2346Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2347values for @samp{method}:
2348
2349@table @samp
2350@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2351Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2352
2353@item report-all
da8bce14 2354Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2355
2356@item ignore-in-object-files
2357Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2358ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2359
2360@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2361Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2362ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2363when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2364libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2365command line.
2366@end table
2367
2368The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2369by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2370
2371Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2372unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2373can change this to a warning.
2374
1715a13c
L
2375@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2376@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2377@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2378@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2379Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2380supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2381the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2382argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2383
2384@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2385@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2386@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2387Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2388used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2389about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2390is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2391see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2392use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2393symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2394@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2395
7ce691ae 2396@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2397@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2398@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2399@item --warn-common
2400Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2401a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2402but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2403you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2404Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2405warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2406
2407There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2408
2409@table @samp
2410@item int i = 1;
2411A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2412file.
2413
2414@item extern int i;
2415An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2416There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2417variable somewhere.
2418
2419@item int i;
2420A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2421variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2422The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2423single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2424size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2425a definition of the same variable.
2426@end table
2427
2428The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2429Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2430just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2431encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2432a common symbol.
2433
2434@enumerate
2435@item
2436Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2437definition for the symbol.
2438@smallexample
2439@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2440 overridden by definition
2441@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2442@end smallexample
2443
2444@item
2445Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2446the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2447except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2448@smallexample
2449@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2450 overriding common
2451@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2452@end smallexample
2453
2454@item
2455Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2456@smallexample
2457@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2458 of `@var{symbol}'
2459@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2460@end smallexample
2461
2462@item
2463Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2464@smallexample
2465@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2466 overridden by larger common
2467@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2468@end smallexample
2469
2470@item
2471Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2472the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2473encountered in a different order.
2474@smallexample
2475@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2476 overriding smaller common
2477@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2478@end smallexample
2479@end enumerate
2480
2481@kindex --warn-constructors
2482@item --warn-constructors
2483Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2484object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2485detect the use of global constructors.
2486
2487@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2488@item --warn-multiple-gp
2489Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2490This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2491Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2492section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2493of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2494base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2495base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2496bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2497large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2498values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2499option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2500
2501@kindex --warn-once
2502@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2503@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2504@item --warn-once
2505Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2506which refers to it.
2507
2508@kindex --warn-section-align
2509@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2510@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2511@item --warn-section-align
2512Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2513alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2514The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2515is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2516the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2517
a6dbf402
L
2518@kindex --warn-textrel
2519@item --warn-textrel
2520Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2521or shared object.
8fdd7217 2522
a0c402a5
L
2523@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2524@item --warn-alternate-em
2525Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2526
560e09e9
NC
2527@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2528@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2529If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2530@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2531This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2532
2533@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2534@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2535This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2536it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2537
252b5132
RH
2538@kindex --whole-archive
2539@cindex including an entire archive
2540@item --whole-archive
2541For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2542@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2543in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2544files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2545library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2546library. This option may be used more than once.
2547
7ec229ce 2548Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2549about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2550Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2551list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2552your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2553
2509a395
SL
2554@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2555@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2556Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2557@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2558undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2559@var{symbol}.
2560
2561This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2562wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2563wishes to call the system function, it should call
2564@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2565
2566Here is a trivial example:
2567
2568@smallexample
2569void *
cc2f008e 2570__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2571@{
cc2f008e 2572 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2573 return __real_malloc (c);
2574@}
2575@end smallexample
2576
ff5dcc92 2577If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2578all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2579instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2580call the real @code{malloc} function.
2581
2582You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2583links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2584you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2585file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2586call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2587
4ea904ed
SH
2588Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2589internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2590@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2591@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2592
2593@smallexample
2594int
2595f (void)
2596@{
2597 return 123;
2598@}
2599
2600int
2601g (void)
2602@{
2603 return f();
2604@}
2605@end smallexample
2606
6aa29e7b 2607@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2608@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2609@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2610@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2611Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2612(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2613section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2614
e41b3a13
JJ
2615@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2616@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2617Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2618generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2619if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2620
6c1439be
L
2621@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2622@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2623@item --enable-new-dtags
2624@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2625This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2626systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2627@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2628and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2629If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2630created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2631those options are only available for ELF systems.
2632
2d643429 2633@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2634@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2635Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2636close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2637time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2638increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2639value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2640
fdc90cb4
JJ
2641@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2642@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2643Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2644@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2645new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2646the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2647hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2648but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2649
0ce398f1
L
2650@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2651@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2652@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2653@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2654@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2655@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2656@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2657@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
9af89fba
NC
2658On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2659compressed using zlib.
2660
2661@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2662sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2663DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2664instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2665also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2666sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2667
2668The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2669@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2670
2671Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2672sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2673for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2674uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2675
2676The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2677involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2678default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2679@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 2680
35835446
JR
2681@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2682@item --reduce-memory-overheads
2683This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 2684linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 2685for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
2686about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2687
4f9c04f7 2688Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 26891021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 2690run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
2691has been used.
2692
2693The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2694enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 2695
c0065db7
RM
2696@kindex --build-id
2697@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2698@item --build-id
2699@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 2700Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 2701or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
2702unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2703@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2704@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2705@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2706the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2707string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2708@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2709is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
2710
2711The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2712that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2713unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2714to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2715file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2716string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
2717
2718Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2719@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
252b5132
RH
2720@end table
2721
0285c67d
NC
2722@c man end
2723
36f63dca 2724@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 2725
0285c67d
NC
2726@c man begin OPTIONS
2727
ff5dcc92 2728The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
2729the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2730normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2731use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2732@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2733like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2734symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2735object file).
2736
2737In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 2738support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
2739PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2740values by either a space or an equals sign.
2741
ff5dcc92 2742@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
2743
2744@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2745@item --add-stdcall-alias
2746If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2747as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 2748[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2749
2750@kindex --base-file
2751@item --base-file @var{file}
2752Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2753addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2754@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 2755[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
2756
2757@kindex --dll
2758@item --dll
2759Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 2760@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 2761file.
bb10df36 2762[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2763
88183869
DK
2764@kindex --enable-long-section-names
2765@kindex --disable-long-section-names
2766@item --enable-long-section-names
2767@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 2768The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 2769the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
2770for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2771fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
2772to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2773allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2774disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2775generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2776as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
2777with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2778GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
2779information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2780option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2781section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2782when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2783image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
2784[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2785
252b5132
RH
2786@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2787@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2788@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2789@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2790If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 2791do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
2792only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2793resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2794undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2795@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2796to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2797warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2798import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 2799to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 2800feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 2801@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 2802mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 2803[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2804
522f09cd
KT
2805@kindex --leading-underscore
2806@kindex --no-leading-underscore
2807@item --leading-underscore
2808@itemx --no-leading-underscore
2809For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2810in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2811disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2812
252b5132
RH
2813@cindex DLLs, creating
2814@kindex --export-all-symbols
2815@item --export-all-symbols
2816If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2817be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2818otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2819explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2820attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2821option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 2822@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 2823@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
2824exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2825re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2826such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
2827@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
2828@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
2829Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
2830not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 2831extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 2832(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 2833These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 2834@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 2835@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 2836@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 2837@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 2838[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2839
2840@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 2841@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
2842Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
2843exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 2844[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2845
2927aaca
NC
2846@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
2847@item --exclude-all-symbols
2848Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
2849[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2850
252b5132
RH
2851@kindex --file-alignment
2852@item --file-alignment
2853Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
2854file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
2855512.
bb10df36 2856[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2857
2858@cindex heap size
2859@kindex --heap
2860@item --heap @var{reserve}
2861@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 2862Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 2863to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 2864committed.
bb10df36 2865[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2866
2867@cindex image base
2868@kindex --image-base
2869@item --image-base @var{value}
2870Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
2871the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
2872is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
2873your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
2874other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
2875for dlls.
bb10df36 2876[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2877
2878@kindex --kill-at
2879@item --kill-at
2880If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
2881symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 2882[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2883
26d2d8a2
BF
2884@kindex --large-address-aware
2885@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 2886If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 2887header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 2888greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
2889or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
2890section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
2891[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2892
f69a2f97
NC
2893@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
2894@item --disable-large-address-aware
2895Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
2896This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
2897driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
2898addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
2899[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2900
252b5132
RH
2901@kindex --major-image-version
2902@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2903Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 2904[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2905
2906@kindex --major-os-version
2907@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2908Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 2909[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2910
2911@kindex --major-subsystem-version
2912@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2913Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 2914[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2915
2916@kindex --minor-image-version
2917@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2918Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2919[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2920
2921@kindex --minor-os-version
2922@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2923Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2924[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2925
2926@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
2927@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2928Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2929[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2930
2931@cindex DEF files, creating
2932@cindex DLLs, creating
2933@kindex --output-def
2934@item --output-def @var{file}
2935The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
2936file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
2937(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
2938library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
2939automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 2940[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2941
b044cda1 2942@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
2943@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
2944@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
2945@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
2946Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
2947@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
2948By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
2949for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
2950execution are avoided.
bb10df36 2951[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
2952
2953@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
2954@item --disable-auto-image-base
2955Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
2956user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
2957default.
bb10df36 2958[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
2959
2960@cindex DLLs, linking to
2961@kindex --dll-search-prefix
2962@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 2963When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 2964search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 2965@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
2966between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
2967uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 2968@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 2969[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
2970
2971@kindex --enable-auto-import
2972@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 2973Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
2974DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
2975mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
2976[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2977
2978The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
2979feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
2980
2981Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
2982of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
2983PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 2984
e2a83dd0
NC
2985Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
2986data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
2987placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
2988around a problem with consts that is described here:
2989http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
2990
4d8907ac
DS
2991Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
2992see this message:
0d888aac 2993
ece2d90e 2994"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
2995documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
2996
ece2d90e
NC
2997This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
2998ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
2999allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3000fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3001constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
3002multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3003this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3004of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3005the warning, and exit.
3006
3007There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3008data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 3009
2fa9fc65
NC
3010One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3011of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 3012this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 3013
c0065db7
RM
3014A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3015that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3016there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
3017a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3018
3019@example
3020extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3021extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3022 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3023@end example
3024
3025or
3026
3027@example
3028extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3029extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3030 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3031@end example
3032
c0065db7 3033For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3034is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3035
3036@example
3037extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3038extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3039 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3040@end example
3041
c406afaf
NC
3042or
3043
3044@example
3045extern long long extern_ll;
3046extern_ll -->
3047 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3048@end example
3049
2fa9fc65 3050A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3051'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3052@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3053requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3054building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3055merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3056between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3057constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3058
3059Original:
3060@example
3061--foo.h
3062extern int arr[];
3063--foo.c
3064#include "foo.h"
3065void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3066 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3067@}
3068@end example
3069
3070Solution 1:
3071@example
3072--foo.h
3073extern int arr[];
3074--foo.c
3075#include "foo.h"
3076void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3077 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3078 volatile int *parr = arr;
3079 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3080@}
3081@end example
3082
3083Solution 2:
3084@example
3085--foo.h
3086/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3087#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3088 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3089#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3090#else
3091#define FOO_IMPORT
3092#endif
3093extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3094--foo.c
3095#include "foo.h"
3096void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3097 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3098@}
3099@end example
3100
c0065db7 3101A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3102library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3103for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3104functions).
b044cda1
CW
3105
3106@kindex --disable-auto-import
3107@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3108Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3109@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3110[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3111
2fa9fc65
NC
3112@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3113@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3114If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3115that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3116a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3117environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3118[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3119
3120@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3121@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3122Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3123[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3124
b044cda1
CW
3125@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3126@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3127Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3128[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3129
252b5132
RH
3130@kindex --section-alignment
3131@item --section-alignment
3132Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3133addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3134[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3135
3136@cindex stack size
3137@kindex --stack
3138@item --stack @var{reserve}
3139@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3140Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3141to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3142committed.
bb10df36 3143[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3144
3145@kindex --subsystem
3146@item --subsystem @var{which}
3147@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3148@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3149Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3150legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3151@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3152the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3153@var{which}.
bb10df36 3154[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3155
2f563b51
DK
3156The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3157of the PE file header:
3158[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3159
2d5c3743
NC
3160@kindex --high-entropy-va
3161@item --high-entropy-va
514b4e19 3162@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
2d5c3743 3163Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
514b4e19
JD
3164(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3165
dc9bd8c9
HD
3166This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3167@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3168
2f563b51
DK
3169@kindex --dynamicbase
3170@item --dynamicbase
514b4e19 3171@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
2f563b51
DK
3172The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3173randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
514b4e19
JD
3174Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3175can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
dc9bd8c9 3176This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3177
3178@kindex --forceinteg
3179@item --forceinteg
514b4e19
JD
3180@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3181Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3182default.
2f563b51
DK
3183
3184@kindex --nxcompat
3185@item --nxcompat
514b4e19 3186@item --disable-nxcompat
2f563b51 3187The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
514b4e19
JD
3188This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3189targets. The option is enabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3190
3191@kindex --no-isolation
3192@item --no-isolation
514b4e19 3193@itemx --disable-no-isolation
2f563b51 3194Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
514b4e19 3195This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3196
3197@kindex --no-seh
3198@item --no-seh
514b4e19 3199@itemx --disable-no-seh
2f563b51 3200The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
514b4e19 3201this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3202
3203@kindex --no-bind
3204@item --no-bind
514b4e19
JD
3205@itemx --disable-no-bind
3206Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3207
3208@kindex --wdmdriver
3209@item --wdmdriver
514b4e19
JD
3210@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3211The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3212by default.
9d5777a3 3213
2f563b51
DK
3214@kindex --tsaware
3215@item --tsaware
514b4e19
JD
3216@itemx --disable-tsaware
3217The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3218default.
2f563b51 3219
0cb112f7
CF
3220@kindex --insert-timestamp
3221@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3222@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3223Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3224as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3225other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3226will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3227same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3228can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3229that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3230identically.
dc9bd8c9
HD
3231
3232@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3233@item --enable-reloc-section
514b4e19 3234@itemx --disable-reloc-section
dc9bd8c9
HD
3235Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3236is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
514b4e19 3237This option is enabled by default.
252b5132
RH
3238@end table
3239
0285c67d
NC
3240@c man end
3241
ac145307
BS
3242@ifset C6X
3243@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3244
3245@c man begin OPTIONS
3246
3247The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3248libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3249all executables use an index of 0.
3250
3251@table @gcctabopt
3252
3253@kindex --dsbt-size
3254@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3255This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3256or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3257entries.
3258
3259@kindex --dsbt-index
3260@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3261This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3262to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3263executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3264@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3265
fbd9ad90
PB
3266@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3267The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3268exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3269
ac145307
BS
3270@end table
3271
3272@c man end
3273@end ifset
3274
b8891f8d
AJ
3275@ifset CSKY
3276@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3277
3278@c man begin OPTIONS
3279
3280@table @gcctabopt
3281
3282@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3283@item --branch-stub
3284This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3285sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3286usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3287can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3288the compiler or assembler.
3289
3290@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3291@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3292This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3293It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3294be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3295stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3296sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3297@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3298linker should choose suitable defaults.
3299
3300@end table
3301
3302@c man end
3303@end ifset
3304
93fd0973
SC
3305@ifset M68HC11
3306@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3307
3308@c man begin OPTIONS
3309
3310The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3311memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3312
3313@table @gcctabopt
3314
3315@kindex --no-trampoline
3316@item --no-trampoline
3317This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3318is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3319instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3320
3321@kindex --bank-window
3322@item --bank-window @var{name}
3323This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3324the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3325The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3326paging and addresses within the memory window.
3327
3328@end table
3329
3330@c man end
3331@end ifset
3332
7fb9f789
NC
3333@ifset M68K
3334@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3335
3336@c man begin OPTIONS
3337
3338The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3339when linking for 68K targets.
3340
3341@table @gcctabopt
3342
3343@kindex --got
3344@item --got=@var{type}
3345This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3346@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3347@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3348Info entry for @file{ld}.
3349
3350@end table
3351
3352@c man end
3353@end ifset
3354
833794fc
MR
3355@ifset MIPS
3356@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3357
3358@c man begin OPTIONS
3359
3360The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3361generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3362linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3363
3364@table @gcctabopt
3365
3366@kindex --insn32
3367@item --insn32
3368@kindex --no-insn32
3369@itemx --no-insn32
3370These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3371generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3372or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
337332-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3374used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3375possible.
3376
8b10b0b3
MR
3377@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3378@item --ignore-branch-isa
3379@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3380@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3381These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3382transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3383accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3384is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3385instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3386equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3387calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3388a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3389an error.
3390
3734320d
MF
3391@kindex --compact-branches
3392@item --compact-branches
3393@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3394@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3395These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3396in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3397
833794fc
MR
3398@end table
3399
3400@c man end
3401@end ifset
3402
fa1477dc
SC
3403
3404@ifset PDP11
3405@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3406
3407@c man begin OPTIONS
3408
3409For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3410produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3411for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3412targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3413defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3414here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3415
3416@table @gcctabopt
3417
3418@kindex -N
3419@item -N
3420@kindex --omagic
3421@itemx --omagic
3422
3423Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3424indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3425shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3426writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3427the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3428programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3429from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3430
3431@kindex -n
3432@item -n
3433@kindex --nmagic
3434@itemx --nmagic
3435
3436Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3437indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3438be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3439file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3440byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3441a @emph{pure executable} format.
3442
3443@kindex -z
3444@item -z
3445@kindex --imagic
3446@itemx --imagic
3447
3448Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3449indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3450data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3451instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3452larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3453to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3454shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3455option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3456and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3457this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3458executable} format.
3459
3460@kindex --no-omagic
3461@item --no-omagic
3462
3463Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3464
3465@end table
3466
3467@c man end
3468@end ifset
3469
252b5132
RH
3470@ifset UsesEnvVars
3471@node Environment
3472@section Environment Variables
3473
0285c67d
NC
3474@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3475
560e09e9 3476You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3477@ifclear SingleFormat
3478@code{GNUTARGET},
3479@end ifclear
3480@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3481
36f63dca 3482@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3483@kindex GNUTARGET
3484@cindex default input format
3485@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3486use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3487of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3488@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3489of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3490attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3491this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3492there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3493object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3494BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3495in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3496@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3497
3498@kindex LDEMULATION
3499@cindex default emulation
3500@cindex emulation, default
3501@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3502@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3503behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3504available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3505the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3506variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3507linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3508
3509@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3510@cindex demangling, default
3511Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3512@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3513default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3514a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3515may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3516options.
3517
0285c67d
NC
3518@c man end
3519@end ifset
3520
252b5132
RH
3521@node Scripts
3522@chapter Linker Scripts
3523
3524@cindex scripts
3525@cindex linker scripts
3526@cindex command files
3527Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3528written in the linker command language.
3529
3530The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3531the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3532the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3533more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3534direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3535described below.
3536
3537The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3538yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3539linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3540to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3541such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3542
3543You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3544line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3545default linker script.
3546
3547You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3548to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3549Linker Scripts}.
3550
3551@menu
3552* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3553* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3554* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3555* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3556* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3557* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3558* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3559* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3560* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3561* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3562* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3563@end menu
3564
3565@node Basic Script Concepts
3566@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3567@cindex linker script concepts
3568We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3569describe the linker script language.
3570
3571The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3572file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3573@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3574The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3575purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3576among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3577section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3578in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3579
3580Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3581also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3582contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3583the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3584A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3585area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3586loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3587which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3588of debugging information.
3589
3590Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3591first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3592the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3593@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3594section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3595same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3596is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3597(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3598based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3599RAM address would be the VMA.
3600
3601You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3602program with the @samp{-h} option.
3603
3604Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3605@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3606has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3607information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3608will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3609static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3610referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3611
3612You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3613program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3614option.
3615
3616@node Script Format
3617@section Linker Script Format
3618@cindex linker script format
3619Linker scripts are text files.
3620
3621You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3622either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3623symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3624generally ignored.
3625
3626Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3627If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3628otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3629double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3630file name.
3631
3632You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3633@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3634to whitespace.
3635
3636@node Simple Example
3637@section Simple Linker Script Example
3638@cindex linker script example
3639@cindex example of linker script
3640Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3641
3642The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3643@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3644memory layout of the output file.
3645
3646The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3647describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3648code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3649@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3650Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3651your input files.
3652
3653For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
36540x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3655linker script which will do that:
3656@smallexample
3657SECTIONS
3658@{
3659 . = 0x10000;
3660 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3661 . = 0x8000000;
3662 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3663 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3664@}
3665@end smallexample
3666
3667You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3668followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3669descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3670
252b5132
RH
3671The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3672sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3673counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3674other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3675current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3676incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3677@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3678
3679The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3680required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3681after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3682which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3683wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3684means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3685
3686Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3687@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3688@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3689
3690The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3691the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3692at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3693output section, the value of the location counter will be
3694@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3695effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 3696immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
3697
3698The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3699alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3700example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3701sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3702may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3703sections.
3704
3705That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3706
3707@node Simple Commands
3708@section Simple Linker Script Commands
3709@cindex linker script simple commands
3710In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3711
3712@menu
3713* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3714* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3715@ifclear SingleFormat
3716* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3717@end ifclear
3718
4a93e180 3719* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
3720* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3721@end menu
3722
3723@node Entry Point
36f63dca 3724@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
3725@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3726@cindex start of execution
3727@cindex first instruction
3728@cindex entry point
3729The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3730point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3731entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3732@smallexample
3733ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3734@end smallexample
3735
3736There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3737entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3738stopping when one of them succeeds:
3739@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 3740@item
252b5132 3741the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 3742@item
252b5132 3743the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 3744@item
a094d01f 3745the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 3746targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 3747check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 3748@item
252b5132 3749the address of the first byte of the @samp{.text} section, if present;
a1ab1d2a 3750@item
252b5132
RH
3751The address @code{0}.
3752@end itemize
3753
3754@node File Commands
36f63dca 3755@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
3756@cindex linker script file commands
3757Several linker script commands deal with files.
3758
3759@table @code
3760@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3761@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3762@cindex including a linker script
3763Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3764be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 3765with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
376610 levels deep.
3767
4006703d
NS
3768You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3769@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3770
252b5132
RH
3771@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3772@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3773@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3774@cindex input files in linker scripts
3775@cindex input object files in linker scripts
3776@cindex linker script input object files
3777The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3778in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3779
3780For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3781a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3782then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3783
3784In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3785script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3786
e3f2db7f
AO
3787In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3788with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3789located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
3790for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3791@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3792filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3793@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3794
3795If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3796the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3797found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3798not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3799path.
252b5132 3800
ff5dcc92 3801If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 3802name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
3803@samp{-l}.
3804
3805When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3806files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3807script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3808
3809@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3810@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3811@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3812@cindex grouping input files
3813The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3814files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3815new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 3816in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 3817
b717d30e
JJ
3818@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3819@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3820@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3821This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3822commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3823as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3824with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
3825when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
3826@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
3827and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
3828setting afterwards.
3829
252b5132
RH
3830@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3831@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 3832@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
3833The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
3834@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
3835@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 3836Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
3837precedence.
3838
3839You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
3840output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
3841
3842@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3843@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3844@cindex library search path in linker script
3845@cindex archive search path in linker script
3846@cindex search path in linker script
3847The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 3848@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 3849@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 3850on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 3851are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 3852the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
3853
3854@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
3855@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
3856@cindex first input file
3857The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
3858that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
3859though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
3860when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
3861first file.
3862@end table
3863
3864@ifclear SingleFormat
3865@node Format Commands
36f63dca 3866@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
3867A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
3868
3869@table @code
3870@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3871@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
3872@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3873@cindex output file format in linker script
3874The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
3875output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 3876exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 3877(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
3878line option takes precedence.
3879
3880You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 3881formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
3882This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
3883desired endianness.
3884
3885If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
3886will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
3887output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
3888used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
3889
3890For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
3891command:
3892@smallexample
3893OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
3894@end smallexample
3895This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 3896@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
3897option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
3898format.
3899
3900@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3901@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3902@cindex input file format in linker script
3903The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
3904files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
3905This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 3906(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
3907is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
3908command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
3909@end table
3910@end ifclear
3911
4a93e180
NC
3912@node REGION_ALIAS
3913@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
3914@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3915@cindex region alias
3916@cindex region names
3917
3918Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
3919@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
3920
3921@smallexample
3922REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3923@end smallexample
3924
3925The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
3926memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
3927to memory regions. An example follows.
3928
3929Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
3930memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
3931that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
3932non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
3933access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
3934read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
3935sections:
3936
3937@itemize @bullet
3938@item
3939@code{.text} program code;
3940@item
3941@code{.rodata} read-only data;
3942@item
3943@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
3944@item
3945@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
3946@end itemize
3947
3948The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
3949part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
3950output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
3951systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
3952@code{C}:
3953@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
3954@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 3955@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
3956@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
3957@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
3958@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
3959@end multitable
3960The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
3961loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
3962the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
3963the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
3964
3965The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
3966includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
3967memory layout:
3968@smallexample
3969INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
3970
3971SECTIONS
3972 @{
3973 .text :
3974 @{
3975 *(.text)
3976 @} > REGION_TEXT
3977 .rodata :
3978 @{
3979 *(.rodata)
3980 rodata_end = .;
3981 @} > REGION_RODATA
3982 .data : AT (rodata_end)
3983 @{
3984 data_start = .;
3985 *(.data)
3986 @} > REGION_DATA
3987 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
3988 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
3989 .bss :
3990 @{
3991 *(.bss)
3992 @} > REGION_BSS
3993 @}
3994@end smallexample
3995
3996Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
3997regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
3998variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
3999@table @code
4000@item A
4001Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4002@smallexample
4003MEMORY
4004 @{
4005 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4006 @}
4007
4008REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4009REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4010REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4011REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4012@end smallexample
4013@item B
4014Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4015into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4016@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4017@smallexample
4018MEMORY
4019 @{
4020 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4021 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4022 @}
4023
4024REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4025REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4026REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4027REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4028@end smallexample
4029@item C
4030Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4031@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4032initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4033system start into the @code{RAM}.
4034@smallexample
4035MEMORY
4036 @{
4037 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4038 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4039 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4040 @}
4041
4042REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4043REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4044REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4045REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4046@end smallexample
4047@end table
4048
4049It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4050@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4051necessary:
4052@smallexample
4053#include <string.h>
4054
4055extern char data_start [];
4056extern char data_size [];
4057extern char data_load_start [];
4058
4059void copy_data(void)
4060@{
4061 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4062 @{
4063 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4064 @}
4065@}
4066@end smallexample
4067
252b5132 4068@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4069@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4070There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4071
4072@table @code
4073@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4074@kindex ASSERT
4075@cindex assertion in linker script
4076Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4077with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4078
fd1c4238
NC
4079Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4080take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4081inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4082for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4083symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4084
4085@smallexample
4086 .stack :
4087 @{
4088 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4089 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4090 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4091 @}
4092@end smallexample
4093
4094will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4095PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4096can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4097
4098@smallexample
4099 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4100 .stack :
4101 @{
4102 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4103 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4104 @}
4105@end smallexample
4106
4107will work.
4108
252b5132
RH
4109@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4110@kindex EXTERN
4111@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4112Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4113symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4114modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4115each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4116command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4117
4118@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4119@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4120@cindex common allocation in linker script
4121This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4122to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4123output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4124
4818e05f
AM
4125@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4126@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4127@cindex common allocation in linker script
4128This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4129command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4130to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4131
7bdf4127
AB
4132@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4133@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4134@cindex group allocation in linker script
4135@cindex section groups
4136@cindex COMDAT
4137This command has the same effect as the
4138@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4139@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4140and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4141specified (@samp{-r}).
4142
53d25da6
AM
4143@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4144@kindex INSERT
4145@cindex insert user script into default script
4146This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4147augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4148inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4149@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4150default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4151sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4152linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4153insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4154linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4155default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4156of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4157to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4158is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4159
4160@smallexample
4161SECTIONS
4162@{
4163 OVERLAY :
4164 @{
4165 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4166 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4167 @}
4168@}
4169INSERT AFTER .text;
4170@end smallexample
4171
252b5132
RH
4172@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4173@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4174@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4175This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4176references among certain output sections.
4177
4178In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4179using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4180will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4181errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4182a function defined in the other section.
4183
4184The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4185@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4186an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4187@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4188names.
4189
cdf96953
MF
4190@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4191@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4192@cindex cross references
4193This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4194references to one section from a list of other sections.
4195
4196The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4197output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4198a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4199there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4200must never call back.
4201
4202The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4203The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4204If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4205the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4206status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4207names, not input section names.
4208
252b5132
RH
4209@ifclear SingleFormat
4210@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4211@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4212@cindex machine architecture
4213@cindex architecture
4214Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4215of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4216architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4217the @samp{-f} option.
4218@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4219
4220@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4221@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4222This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4223@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4224in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4225@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4226@end table
4227
4228@node Assignments
4229@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4230@cindex assignment in scripts
4231@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4232@cindex variables, defining
4233You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4234the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4235
4236@menu
4237* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4238* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4239* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4240* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4241* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4242@end menu
4243
4244@node Simple Assignments
4245@subsection Simple Assignments
4246
4247You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4248
4249@table @code
4250@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4251@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4252@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4253@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4254@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4255@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4256@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4257@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4258@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4259@end table
4260
4261The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4262@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4263defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4264
4265The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4266may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4267
4268The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4269
4270Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4271
4272You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4273statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4274section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4275
4276The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4277expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4278
4279Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4280assignments may be used:
4281
4282@smallexample
4283floating_point = 0;
4284SECTIONS
4285@{
4286 .text :
4287 @{
4288 *(.text)
4289 _etext = .;
4290 @}
156e34dd 4291 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4292 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4293@}
4294@end smallexample
4295@noindent
4296In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4297zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4298the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4299defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4300upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4301
eb8476a6
MR
4302@node HIDDEN
4303@subsection HIDDEN
4304@cindex HIDDEN
4305For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4306exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4307
4308Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4309@code{HIDDEN}:
4310
4311@smallexample
4312HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4313SECTIONS
4314@{
4315 .text :
4316 @{
4317 *(.text)
4318 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4319 @}
4320 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4321 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4322@}
4323@end smallexample
4324@noindent
4325In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4326
252b5132
RH
4327@node PROVIDE
4328@subsection PROVIDE
4329@cindex PROVIDE
4330In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4331only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4332the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4333@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4334@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4335@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4336@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4337@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4338
4339Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4340@smallexample
4341SECTIONS
4342@{
4343 .text :
4344 @{
4345 *(.text)
4346 _etext = .;
4347 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4348 @}
4349@}
4350@end smallexample
4351
4352In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4353underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition error. If, on
4354the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4355underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4356If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4357linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4358
b0daac83
NC
4359Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4360defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4361that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4362when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4363@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4364
7af8e998
L
4365@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4366@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4367@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4368Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4369hidden and won't be exported.
4370
73ae6183
NC
4371@node Source Code Reference
4372@subsection Source Code Reference
4373
4374Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4375intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4376a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4377symbol that does not have a value.
4378
4379Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4380transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4381stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4382prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4383mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4384of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4385variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4386linker script variable might be referred to as:
4387
4388@smallexample
4389 extern int foo;
4390@end smallexample
4391
4392But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4393
4394@smallexample
4395 _foo = 1000;
4396@end smallexample
4397
4398In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4399transformation has taken place.
4400
4401When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4402things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4403in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4404second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4405table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4406contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4407value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4408
4409@smallexample
4410 int foo = 1000;
4411@end smallexample
4412
10bf6894 4413creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4414holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4415number 1000 is initially stored.
4416
4417When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4418first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4419memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4420So:
4421
4422@smallexample
4423 foo = 1;
4424@end smallexample
4425
4426looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4427associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4428address. Whereas:
4429
4430@smallexample
4431 int * a = & foo;
4432@end smallexample
4433
10bf6894 4434looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4435and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4436the variable @samp{a}.
4437
4438Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4439the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4440an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4441
4442@smallexample
4443 foo = 1000;
4444@end smallexample
4445
4446creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4447the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4448address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4449linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4450access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4451
4452Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4453you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4454use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4455section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4456linker script contains these declarations:
4457
4458@smallexample
4459@group
4460 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4461 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4462 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4463@end group
4464@end smallexample
4465
4466Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4467
4468@smallexample
4469@group
4470 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4471
73ae6183
NC
4472 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4473@end group
4474@end smallexample
4475
4476Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4477Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4478arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4479
4480@smallexample
4481@group
4482 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4483
4484 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4485@end group
4486@end smallexample
4487
4488Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4489operators.
73ae6183 4490
252b5132 4491@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4492@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4493@kindex SECTIONS
4494The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4495into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4496
4497The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4498@smallexample
4499SECTIONS
4500@{
4501 @var{sections-command}
4502 @var{sections-command}
4503 @dots{}
4504@}
4505@end smallexample
4506
4507Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4508
4509@itemize @bullet
4510@item
4511an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4512@item
4513a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4514@item
4515an output section description
4516@item
4517an overlay description
4518@end itemize
4519
4520The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4521@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4522those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4523understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4524the layout of the output file.
4525
4526Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4527below.
4528
4529If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4530linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4531section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4532input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4533example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4534in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4535
4536@menu
4537* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4538* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4539* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4540* Input Section:: Input section description
4541* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4542* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4543* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4544* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4545* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4546@end menu
4547
4548@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4549@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4550The full description of an output section looks like this:
4551@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4552@group
7e7d5768 4553@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4554 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4555 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4556 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4557 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4558 @{
4559 @var{output-section-command}
4560 @var{output-section-command}
4561 @dots{}
abc9061b 4562 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4563@end group
4564@end smallexample
4565
4566Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4567
4568The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4569name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4570The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4571the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4572The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4573
4574Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4575
4576@itemize @bullet
4577@item
4578a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4579@item
4580an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4581@item
4582data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4583@item
4584a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4585@end itemize
4586
4587@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4588@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4589@cindex name, section
4590@cindex section name
4591The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4592meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4593support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4594must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4595example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4596output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4597names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4598quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4599characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4600commas must be quoted.
4601
4602The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4603Discarding}.
4604
4605@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4606@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4607@cindex address, section
4608@cindex section address
4609The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4610address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4611is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4612
4613If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4614section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4615to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4616alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4617contained within the output section.
4618
4619The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4620
4621@itemize @bullet
4622@item
4623If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4624is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4625in that region.
4626
4627@item
4628If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4629regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4630section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4631be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4632
4633@item
4634If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4635the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4636counter.
4637@end itemize
4638
4639@noindent
4640For example:
4641
252b5132
RH
4642@smallexample
4643.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4644@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4645
252b5132
RH
4646@noindent
4647and
ea5cae92 4648
252b5132
RH
4649@smallexample
4650.text : @{ *(.text) @}
4651@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4652
252b5132
RH
4653@noindent
4654are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4655@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4656counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
4657counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4658input sections.
252b5132
RH
4659
4660The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4661For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4662so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4663do something like this:
4664@smallexample
4665.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4666@end smallexample
4667@noindent
4668This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4669aligned upward to the specified value.
4670
4671Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
4672location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4673sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
4674
4675@node Input Section
36f63dca 4676@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
4677@cindex input sections
4678@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4679The most common output section command is an input section description.
4680
4681The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4682You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4683in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4684map the input files into your memory layout.
4685
4686@menu
4687* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4688* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4689* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4690* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4691* Input Section Example:: Input section example
4692@end menu
4693
4694@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 4695@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
4696@cindex input section basics
4697An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4698by a list of section names in parentheses.
4699
4700The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4701describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4702
4703The most common input section description is to include all input
4704sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4705include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4706@smallexample
4707*(.text)
4708@end smallexample
4709@noindent
18625d54 4710Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 4711@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
4712of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4713match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4714example:
252b5132 4715@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4716EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4717@end smallexample
4718@noindent
4719will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4720and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4721placed inside the section list, for example:
4722@smallexample
b4346c09 4723*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 4724@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4725@noindent
4726The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4727two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4728more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
4729
4730There are two ways to include more than one section:
4731@smallexample
4732*(.text .rdata)
4733*(.text) *(.rdata)
4734@end smallexample
4735@noindent
4736The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4737@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
4738first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4739they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
4740@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4741@samp{.rdata} input sections.
4742
8f1732fc
AB
4743When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4744is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4745immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4746@smallexample
4747*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4748@end smallexample
4749@noindent
4750will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4751@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4752from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4753exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 4754could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4755@smallexample
4756*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4757@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4758@noindent
4759Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4760before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4761all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4762@smallexample
4763EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4764@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 4765
252b5132
RH
4766You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4767You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4768needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4769@smallexample
4770data.o(.data)
4771@end smallexample
4772
ae17ab41
CM
4773To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4774of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4775
4776Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4777
4778@smallexample
4779@group
4780SECTIONS @{
4781 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4782 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4783@}
4784@end group
4785@end smallexample
4786
4787In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4788input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4789@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4790@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4791whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4792
967928e9
AM
4793You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4794matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4795with no whitespace around the colon.
4796
4797@table @samp
4798@item archive:file
4799matches file within archive
4800@item archive:
4801matches the whole archive
4802@item :file
4803matches file but not one in an archive
4804@end table
4805
4806Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4807wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4808single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4809@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4810within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4811also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4812other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4813from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4814command.
4815
252b5132
RH
4816If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4817the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4818commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4819@smallexample
4820data.o
4821@end smallexample
4822
967928e9
AM
4823When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4824and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
4825characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
4826name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
4827did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
4828though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
4829@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
4830the archive search path.
4831
4832@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 4833@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
4834@cindex input section wildcards
4835@cindex wildcard file name patterns
4836@cindex file name wildcard patterns
4837@cindex section name wildcard patterns
4838In an input section description, either the file name or the section
4839name or both may be wildcard patterns.
4840
4841The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
4842pattern for the file name.
4843
4844The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
4845
4846@table @samp
4847@item *
4848matches any number of characters
4849@item ?
4850matches any single character
4851@item [@var{chars}]
4852matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
4853character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
4854@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
4855@item \
4856quotes the following character
4857@end table
4858
4859When a file name is matched with a wildcard, the wildcard characters
4860will not match a @samp{/} character (used to separate directory names on
4861Unix). A pattern consisting of a single @samp{*} character is an
4862exception; it will always match any file name, whether it contains a
4863@samp{/} or not. In a section name, the wildcard characters will match
4864a @samp{/} character.
4865
4866File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
4867specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
4868does not search directories to expand wildcards.
4869
4870If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
4871appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
4872will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
4873sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
4874@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
4875@smallexample
4876.data : @{ *(.data) @}
4877.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
4878@end smallexample
4879
bcaa7b3e 4880@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
4881Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
4882in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
4883this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
4884pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
4885@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
4886into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
4887
bcaa7b3e 4888@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
4889@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4890@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
4891alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
4892alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
4893needed.
bcaa7b3e 4894
02ecc8e9 4895@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
4896@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4897@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
4898numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
4899section name before placing them in the output file. In
4900@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
4901the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
4902@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 4903
bcaa7b3e
L
4904@cindex SORT
4905@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4906
4907When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
4908can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
4909
4910@enumerate
4911@item
4912@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 4913It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
4914sections have the same name.
4915@item
4916@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 4917It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
4918sections have the same alignment.
4919@item
c0065db7 4920@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
4921treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
4922@item
4923@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
4924is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
4925@item
4926All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
4927@end enumerate
4928
a05a5b64 4929When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 4930section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 4931takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
4932
4933If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 4934command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
4935treated as nested sorting command.
4936
4937@enumerate
4938@item
4939@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
4940@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
4941@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
4942@item
4943@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
4944@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
4945@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
4946@end enumerate
4947
4948If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 4949command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 4950
eda680f8 4951@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 4952@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
4953section sorting option.
4954
252b5132
RH
4955If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
4956@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
4957precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
4958
4959This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
4960files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
4961sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
4962The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
4963with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
4964linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
4965@smallexample
4966@group
4967SECTIONS @{
4968 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4969 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
4970 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4971 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
4972@}
4973@end group
4974@end smallexample
4975
4976@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 4977@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
4978@cindex common symbol placement
4979@cindex uninitialized data placement
4980A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
4981file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
4982linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
4983named @samp{COMMON}.
4984
4985You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
4986other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
4987particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
4988input files are placed in another section.
4989
4990In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
4991@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
4992@smallexample
4993.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
4994@end smallexample
4995
4996@cindex scommon section
4997@cindex small common symbols
4998Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
4999example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5000symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5001different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5002the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5003symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5004to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5005locations.
5006
5007@cindex [COMMON]
5008You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5009notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5010@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5011
5012@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 5013@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
5014@cindex KEEP
5015@cindex garbage collection
5016When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 5017it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
5018This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5019with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 5020@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
5021
5022@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 5023@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
5024The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5025to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5026start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5027@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5028follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5029@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5030@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5031All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5032files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5033
5034@smallexample
5035@group
5036SECTIONS @{
5037 outputa 0x10000 :
5038 @{
5039 all.o
5040 foo.o (.input1)
5041 @}
36f63dca
NC
5042@end group
5043@group
252b5132
RH
5044 outputb :
5045 @{
5046 foo.o (.input2)
5047 foo1.o (.input1)
5048 @}
36f63dca
NC
5049@end group
5050@group
252b5132
RH
5051 outputc :
5052 @{
5053 *(.input1)
5054 *(.input2)
5055 @}
5056@}
5057@end group
a1ab1d2a 5058@end smallexample
252b5132 5059
cbd0eecf
L
5060If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5061and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5062automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5063__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5064indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5065respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5066C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5067
252b5132 5068@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5069@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5070@cindex data
5071@cindex section data
5072@cindex output section data
5073@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5074@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5075@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5076@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5077@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5078You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5079@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5080an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5081parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5082value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5083counter.
5084
5085The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5086store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5087bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5088stored.
5089
5090For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5091of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5092@smallexample
5093BYTE(1)
5094LONG(addr)
5095@end smallexample
5096
5097When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5098same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5099target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5100@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5101@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5102
5103If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5104which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5105When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5106true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5107endianness of the first input object file.
5108
36f63dca 5109Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5110between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5111@smallexample
5112SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5113@end smallexample
5114whereas this will work:
5115@smallexample
5116SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5117@end smallexample
5118
252b5132
RH
5119@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5120@cindex holes, filling
5121@cindex unspecified memory
5122You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5123current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5124otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5125gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5126with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5127necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5128point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5129than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5130different parts of an output section.
5131
5132This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5133value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5134@smallexample
563e308f 5135FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5136@end smallexample
5137
5138The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5139section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5140part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5141entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5142precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5143expression.
252b5132
RH
5144
5145@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5146@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5147There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5148commands.
5149
5150@table @code
5151@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5152@cindex input filename symbols
5153@cindex filename symbols
5154@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5155The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5156The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5157file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5158the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5159
5160This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5161normally used for any other object file format.
5162
5163@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5164@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5165@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5166@item CONSTRUCTORS
5167When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5168unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5169destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5170arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5171automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5172For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5173linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5174@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5175ignored for other object file formats.
5176
5177The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5178constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5179Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5180the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5181first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5182of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5183compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5184formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5185@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5186the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5187destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5188@code{exit}.
5189
5190For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5191arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5192addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5193and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5194linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5195runtime code expects to see.
5196
5197@smallexample
5198 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5199 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5200 *(.ctors)
5201 LONG(0)
5202 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5203 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5204 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5205 *(.dtors)
5206 LONG(0)
5207 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5208@end smallexample
5209
5210If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5211which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5212are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5213are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5214command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5215@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5216@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5217@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5218
5219Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5220and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5221need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5222scripts.
5223
5224@end table
5225
5226@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5227@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5228@cindex discarding sections
5229@cindex sections, discarding
5230@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5231The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5232This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5233may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5234@smallexample
49c13adb 5235.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5236@end smallexample
5237@noindent
5238will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5239@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5240sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5241space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5242too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5243space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5244@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5245@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5246This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5247
a0976ea4 5248The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5249on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5250symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5251the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5252section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5253
5254@cindex /DISCARD/
5255The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5256input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5257section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5258
a2e098c3
NC
5259Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5260discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5261members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5262Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5263
252b5132 5264@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5265@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5266@cindex output section attributes
5267We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5268like this:
0c71d759 5269
252b5132 5270@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5271@group
7e7d5768 5272@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5273 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5274 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5275 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5276 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5277 @{
5278 @var{output-section-command}
5279 @var{output-section-command}
5280 @dots{}
562d3460 5281 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5282@end group
5283@end smallexample
0c71d759 5284
252b5132
RH
5285We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5286@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5287remaining section attributes.
5288
a1ab1d2a 5289@menu
252b5132
RH
5290* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5291* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5292* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5293* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5294* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5295* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5296* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5297* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5298@end menu
5299
5300@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5301@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5302Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5303parentheses. The following types are defined:
5304
5305@table @code
5306@item NOLOAD
5307The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5308loaded into memory when the program is run.
5309@item DSECT
5310@itemx COPY
5311@itemx INFO
5312@itemx OVERLAY
5313These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5314rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5315marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5316section when the program is run.
5317@end table
5318
5319@kindex NOLOAD
5320@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5321@cindex loading, preventing
5322The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5323the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5324the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5325@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5326need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5327@smallexample
5328@group
5329SECTIONS @{
5330 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5331 @dots{}
5332@}
5333@end group
5334@end smallexample
5335
5336@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5337@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5338@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5339@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5340@cindex load address
5341@cindex section load address
5342Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5343@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5344@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5345specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5346address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5347
ea5cae92
NC
5348The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5349specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5350takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5351load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5352region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5353
5354If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5355section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5356load address:
5357
5358@itemize @bullet
5359@item
5360If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5361the LMA address as well.
5362
5363@item
5364If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5365
5366@item
5367Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5368with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5369section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5370VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5371the last section in the located region.
5372
5373@item
5374If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5375that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5376
5377@item
5378If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5379section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5380@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5381
5382@cindex ROM initialized data
5383@cindex initialized data in ROM
5384This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5385example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5386called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5387@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5388even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5389uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5390defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5391counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5392
5393@smallexample
5394@group
5395SECTIONS
5396 @{
5397 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5398 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5399 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5400 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5401 .bss 0x3000 :
5402 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5403@}
5404@end group
5405@end smallexample
5406
5407The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5408this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5409the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5410how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5411script.
5412
5413@smallexample
5414@group
5415extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5416char *src = &_etext;
5417char *dst = &_data;
5418
ea5cae92
NC
5419/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5420while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5421 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5422
ea5cae92 5423/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5424for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5425 *dst = 0;
5426@end group
5427@end smallexample
5428
bbf115d3
L
5429@node Forced Output Alignment
5430@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5431@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5432@cindex forcing output section alignment
5433@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5434You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5435alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5436intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5437
7e7d5768
AM
5438@node Forced Input Alignment
5439@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5440@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5441@cindex forcing input section alignment
5442@cindex input section alignment
5443You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5444SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5445sections, whether larger or smaller.
5446
0c71d759
NC
5447@node Output Section Constraint
5448@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5449@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5450@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5451@cindex constraints on output sections
5452You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5453of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5454read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5455@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5456
252b5132 5457@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5458@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5459@kindex >@var{region}
5460@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5461@cindex memory regions and sections
5462You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5463using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5464
5465Here is a simple example:
5466@smallexample
5467@group
5468MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5469SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5470@end group
5471@end smallexample
5472
5473@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5474@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5475@kindex :@var{phdr}
5476@cindex section, assigning to program header
5477@cindex program headers and sections
5478You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5479using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5480one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5481assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5482@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5483linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5484
5485Here is a simple example:
5486@smallexample
5487@group
5488PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5489SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5490@end group
5491@end smallexample
5492
5493@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5494@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5495@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5496@cindex section fill pattern
5497@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5498You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5499@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5500(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5501within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5502alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5503necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5504of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5505an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5506fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5507other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5508pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5509expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5510
5511You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5512output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5513
5514Here is a simple example:
5515@smallexample
5516@group
563e308f 5517SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5518@end group
5519@end smallexample
5520
5521@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5522@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5523@kindex OVERLAY
5524@cindex overlays
5525An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5526are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5527the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5528copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5529required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5530can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5531than another.
5532
5533Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5534@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5535output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5536command is as follows:
5537@smallexample
5538@group
5539OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5540 @{
5541 @var{secname1}
5542 @{
5543 @var{output-section-command}
5544 @var{output-section-command}
5545 @dots{}
5546 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5547 @var{secname2}
5548 @{
5549 @var{output-section-command}
5550 @var{output-section-command}
5551 @dots{}
5552 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5553 @dots{}
abc9061b 5554 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5555@end group
5556@end smallexample
5557
5558Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5559section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5560section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5561those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5562except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5563sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5564
abc9061b
CC
5565The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5566the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5567
252b5132
RH
5568The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5569addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5570memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5571whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5572and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5573and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5574
56dd11f0
NC
5575If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5576references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5577the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5578sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5579@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
5580
5581For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 5582provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
5583defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5584@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5585the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5586within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5587symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5588
5589At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5590the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5591
5592Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5593@code{SECTIONS} construct.
5594@smallexample
5595@group
5596 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5597 @{
5598 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5599 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5600 @}
5601@end group
5602@end smallexample
5603@noindent
5604This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5605address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5606@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 5607following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
5608@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5609@code{__load_stop_text1}.
5610
5611C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5612like the following.
5613
5614@smallexample
5615@group
5616 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5617 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5618 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5619@end group
5620@end smallexample
5621
5622Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5623everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5624example could have been written identically as follows.
5625
5626@smallexample
5627@group
5628 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5629 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5630 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 5631 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5632 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5633 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
5634 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5635@end group
5636@end smallexample
5637
5638@node MEMORY
36f63dca 5639@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
5640@kindex MEMORY
5641@cindex memory regions
5642@cindex regions of memory
5643@cindex allocating memory
5644@cindex discontinuous memory
5645The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5646memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5647
5648The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5649memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5650may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5651can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5652set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5653regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5654around to fit into the available regions.
5655
127fcdff
AB
5656A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5657however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5658specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5659@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
5660@smallexample
5661@group
a1ab1d2a 5662MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5663 @{
5664 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5665 @dots{}
5666 @}
5667@end group
5668@end smallexample
5669
5670The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5671region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5672Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5673with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
5674must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5675add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 5676command.
252b5132
RH
5677
5678@cindex memory region attributes
5679The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5680whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5681not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5682@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5683section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5684the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5685them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5686
5687The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5688@table @samp
5689@item R
5690Read-only section
5691@item W
5692Read/write section
5693@item X
5694Executable section
5695@item A
5696Allocatable section
5697@item I
5698Initialized section
5699@item L
5700Same as @samp{I}
5701@item !
c09e9a8c 5702Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
5703@end table
5704
81c688d5 5705If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 5706@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
5707attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5708unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5709not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5710string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5711or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5712the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
5713
5714@kindex ORIGIN =
5715@kindex o =
5716@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
5717The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5718the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5719cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5720abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5721@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
5722
5723@kindex LENGTH =
5724@kindex len =
5725@kindex l =
5726The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5727region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
5728be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5729@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
5730
5731In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5732available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5733and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5734linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5735is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5736or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5737explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5738region.
5739
5740@smallexample
5741@group
a1ab1d2a 5742MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5743 @{
5744 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5745 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5746 @}
5747@end group
5748@end smallexample
5749
5750Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5751specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5752@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5753a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5754output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5755was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5756the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5757output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5758region, the linker will issue an error message.
5759
3ec57632 5760It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 5761expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
5762@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5763
5764@smallexample
5765@group
c0065db7 5766 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
5767@end group
5768@end smallexample
5769
252b5132
RH
5770@node PHDRS
5771@section PHDRS Command
5772@kindex PHDRS
5773@cindex program headers
5774@cindex ELF program headers
5775@cindex program segments
5776@cindex segments, ELF
5777The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5778@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5779loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5780program with the @samp{-p} option.
5781
5782When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5783reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5784program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5785This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5786interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5787
5788The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5789in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5790precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5791the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5792not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5793
5794The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5795generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5796ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5797
5798This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5799@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5800
5801@smallexample
5802@group
5803PHDRS
5804@{
5805 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5806 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5807@}
5808@end group
5809@end smallexample
5810
5811The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5812of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5813header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5814with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
5815must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5816is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
5817
5818Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5819system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5820specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5821sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5822attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5823Section Phdr}.
5824
5825It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
5826merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
5827repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
5828contain the section.
5829
5830If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
5831then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
5832not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
5833convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
5834placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
5835default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
5836segment at all.
5837
5838@kindex FILEHDR
5839@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 5840You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
5841the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
5842The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
5843file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 5844include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
5845segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
5846these keywords.
252b5132
RH
5847
5848The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
5849value of the keyword.
5850
5851@table @asis
5852@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
5853Indicates an unused program header.
5854
5855@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
5856Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
5857the file.
5858
5859@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
5860Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
5861
5862@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
5863Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
5864found.
5865
5866@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
5867Indicates a segment holding note information.
5868
5869@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
5870A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
5871ABI.
5872
5873@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
5874Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
5875
1a9ccd70
NC
5876@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
5877Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
5878
252b5132
RH
5879@item @var{expression}
5880An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
5881be used for types not defined above.
5882@end table
5883
5884You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
5885in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
5886@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
5887Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
5888output section attribute.
5889
5890The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
5891which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
5892explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
5893an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
5894header.
5895
5896Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
5897headers used on a native ELF system.
5898
5899@example
5900@group
5901PHDRS
5902@{
5903 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
5904 interp PT_INTERP ;
5905 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
5906 data PT_LOAD ;
5907 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
5908@}
5909
5910SECTIONS
5911@{
5912 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
5913 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
5914 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
5915 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
5916 @dots{}
5917 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
5918 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
5919 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
5920 @dots{}
5921@}
5922@end group
5923@end example
5924
5925@node VERSION
5926@section VERSION Command
5927@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
5928@cindex symbol versions
5929@cindex version script
5930@cindex versions of symbols
5931The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
5932only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
5933symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
5934a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
5935shared library.
5936
5937You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
5938you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
5939also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
5940
5941The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
5942@smallexample
5943VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
5944@end smallexample
5945
5946The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
5947Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
5948version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
5949version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
5950version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
5951scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
5952library.
5953
5954The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
5955examples.
5956
5957@smallexample
5958VERS_1.1 @{
5959 global:
5960 foo1;
5961 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
5962 old*;
5963 original*;
5964 new*;
252b5132
RH
5965@};
5966
5967VERS_1.2 @{
5968 foo2;
5969@} VERS_1.1;
5970
5971VERS_2.0 @{
5972 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 5973 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 5974 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
5975 "f(int, double)";
5976 @};
252b5132
RH
5977@} VERS_1.2;
5978@end smallexample
5979
5980This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
5981version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
5982The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
5983a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
5984of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
5985symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
5986is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
5987in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
5988However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
5989name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
5990
5991Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
5992depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
5993to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
5994
5995Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
5996depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
5997and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
5998
5999When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6000specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6001unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 6002unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
6003somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6004wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6005wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6006set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6007ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
6008
6009The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6010they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6011could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6012However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6013
0f6bf451 6014Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
6015in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6016symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6017won't.
6018
6019@smallexample
7c9c73be 6020@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 6021@end smallexample
6b9b879a 6022
252b5132
RH
6023When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6024symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6025requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6026shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6027loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6028linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6029application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6030way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6031all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6032search for each symbol reference.
6033
6034The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6035doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6036that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6037functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6038the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6039required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6040that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6041versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6042the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6043
6044There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6045first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6046source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6047script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6048maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6049@smallexample
6050__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6051@end smallexample
6052@noindent
6053in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6054be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6055The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6056@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6057takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6058
6059The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6060function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6061an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6062version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6063linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6064
6065To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6066source file. Here is an example:
6067
6068@smallexample
6069__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6070__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6071__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6072__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6073@end smallexample
6074
6075In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6076unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6077example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6078@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6079
6080When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6081some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6082this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6083@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6084declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6085you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6086
6087If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6088within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6089(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6090specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6091
cb840a31
L
6092You can also specify the language in the version script:
6093
6094@smallexample
6095VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6096@end smallexample
6097
c0065db7 6098The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6099The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6100demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6101patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6102@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6103
86043bbb
MM
6104Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6105described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6106or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6107the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6108whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6109cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6110might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6111should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6112expect when you upgrade.
6113
252b5132
RH
6114@node Expressions
6115@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6116@cindex expressions
6117@cindex arithmetic
6118The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6119that of C expressions. All expressions are evaluated as integers. All
6120expressions are evaluated in the same size, which is 32 bits if both the
6121host and target are 32 bits, and is otherwise 64 bits.
6122
6123You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6124
6125The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6126expressions.
6127
6128@menu
6129* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6130* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6131* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6132* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6133* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6134* Operators:: Operators
6135* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6136* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6137* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6138@end menu
6139
6140@node Constants
6141@subsection Constants
6142@cindex integer notation
6143@cindex constants in linker scripts
6144All constants are integers.
6145
6146As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6147octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6148hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6149@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6150@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6151value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6152
6153@cindex scaled integers
6154@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6155@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6156@cindex suffixes for integers
6157@cindex integer suffixes
6158In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6159constant by
6160@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6161@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6162@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6163@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6164@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6165@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6166@tex
6167${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6168@end tex
6169@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6170respectively. For example, the following
6171all refer to the same quantity:
6172
252b5132 6173@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6174_fourk_1 = 4K;
6175_fourk_2 = 4096;
6176_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6177_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6178@end smallexample
6179
8a308ae8
NC
6180Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6181conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6182
0c71d759
NC
6183@node Symbolic Constants
6184@subsection Symbolic Constants
6185@cindex symbolic constants
6186@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6187It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6188the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6189
6190@table @code
6191@item MAXPAGESIZE
6192@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6193The target's maximum page size.
6194
6195@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6196@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6197The target's default page size.
6198@end table
6199
6200So for example:
6201
6202@smallexample
9d5777a3 6203 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6204@end smallexample
6205
6206will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6207supported by the target.
6208
252b5132
RH
6209@node Symbols
6210@subsection Symbol Names
6211@cindex symbol names
6212@cindex names
6213@cindex quoted symbol names
6214@kindex "
6215Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6216and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6217Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6218specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6219keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6220@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6221"SECTION" = 9;
6222"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6223@end smallexample
6224
6225Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6226to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6227whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6228
ecca9871
L
6229@node Orphan Sections
6230@subsection Orphan Sections
6231@cindex orphan
6232Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6233are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6234script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6235output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6236in which to place the orphaned input section.
6237
6238If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6239an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6240placed at the end of that output section.
6241
6242If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6243sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6244name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6245orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6246one new output section.
6247
6248If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6249then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6250in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6251linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6252attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6253sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6254support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6255
a05a5b64
TP
6256The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6257(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6258output sections an orphan is placed in.
6259
252b5132
RH
6260@node Location Counter
6261@subsection The Location Counter
6262@kindex .
6263@cindex dot
6264@cindex location counter
6265@cindex current output location
6266The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6267current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6268location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6269within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6270anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6271
6272@cindex holes
6273Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6274moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6275location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6276and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6277doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6278
6279@smallexample
6280SECTIONS
6281@{
6282 output :
6283 @{
6284 file1(.text)
6285 . = . + 1000;
6286 file2(.text)
6287 . += 1000;
6288 file3(.text)
563e308f 6289 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6290@}
6291@end smallexample
6292@noindent
6293In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6294located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6295followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6296@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6297@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6298specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6299
5c6bbab8
NC
6300@cindex dot inside sections
6301Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6302current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6303statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6304absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6305however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6306not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6307
6308@smallexample
6309SECTIONS
6310@{
6311 . = 0x100
6312 .text: @{
6313 *(.text)
6314 . = 0x200
6315 @}
6316 . = 0x500
6317 .data: @{
6318 *(.data)
6319 . += 0x600
6320 @}
6321@}
6322@end smallexample
6323
6324The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6325and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6326the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6327much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6328move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6329and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6330the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6331the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6332
b5666f2f
AM
6333@cindex dot outside sections
6334Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6335output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6336needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6337
6338@smallexample
6339SECTIONS
6340@{
6341 start_of_text = . ;
6342 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6343 end_of_text = . ;
6344
6345 start_of_data = . ;
6346 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6347 end_of_data = . ;
6348@}
6349@end smallexample
6350
6351If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6352not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6353between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6354should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6355blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6356the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6357sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6358statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6359special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6360place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6361as follows:
6362
6363@smallexample
6364SECTIONS
6365@{
6366 start_of_text = . ;
6367 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6368 end_of_text = . ;
6369
6370 start_of_data = . ;
6371 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6372 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6373 end_of_data = . ;
6374@}
6375@end smallexample
6376
6377This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6378@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6379placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6380assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6381a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6382section. So you could write:
6383
6384@smallexample
6385SECTIONS
6386@{
6387 start_of_text = . ;
6388 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6389 end_of_text = . ;
6390
6391 . = . ;
6392 start_of_data = . ;
6393 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6394 end_of_data = . ;
6395@}
6396@end smallexample
6397
6398Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6399@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6400
252b5132
RH
6401@need 2000
6402@node Operators
6403@subsection Operators
6404@cindex operators for arithmetic
6405@cindex arithmetic operators
6406@cindex precedence in expressions
6407The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6408the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6409@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6410@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6411@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6412@smallexample
6413precedence associativity Operators Notes
6414(highest)
64151 left ! - ~ (1)
64162 left * / %
64173 left + -
64184 left >> <<
64195 left == != > < <= >=
64206 left &
64217 left |
64228 left &&
64239 left ||
642410 right ? :
642511 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6426(lowest)
6427@end smallexample
6428Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6429(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6430(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6431@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6432@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6433@tex
6434\vskip \baselineskip
6435%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6436\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6437\hrule
6438\halign
6439{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6440height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6441&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6442height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6443\noalign{\hrule}
6444height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6445&highest&&&&&\cr
6446% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6447&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6448&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6449&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6450&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6451&5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6452&6&&left&&\&&\cr
6453&7&&left&&|&\cr
6454&8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6455&9&&left&&||&\cr
6456&10&&right&&? :&\cr
6457&11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6458&lowest&&&&&\cr
6459height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6460\hrule}
6461@end tex
6462@iftex
6463{
6464@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6465@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6466@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6467}
6468@end iftex
6469@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6470
6471@node Evaluation
6472@subsection Evaluation
6473@cindex lazy evaluation
6474@cindex expression evaluation order
6475The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6476an expression when absolutely necessary.
6477
6478The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6479address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6480regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6481as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6482
6483However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6484until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6485other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6486for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6487
6488The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6489assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6490allocation.
6491
6492Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6493@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6494
6495If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6496available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6497following
6498@smallexample
6499@group
6500SECTIONS
6501 @{
a1ab1d2a 6502 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6503 @{ *(.text) @}
6504 @}
6505@end group
6506@end smallexample
6507@noindent
6508will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6509address}.
6510
6511@node Expression Section
6512@subsection The Section of an Expression
6513@cindex expression sections
6514@cindex absolute expressions
6515@cindex relative expressions
6516@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6517@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6518@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6519Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6520relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6521using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6522value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6523symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6524operations.
6525
abf4be64
AM
6526Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6527section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6528address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6529@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6530functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6531One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6532(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6533differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6534versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6535section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6536Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6537absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6538given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6539everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6540
6541In the following simple example,
252b5132 6542
7542af2a
AM
6543@smallexample
6544@group
6545SECTIONS
6546 @{
6547 . = 0x100;
6548 __executable_start = 0x100;
6549 .data :
6550 @{
6551 . = 0x10;
6552 __data_start = 0x10;
6553 *(.data)
6554 @}
6555 @dots{}
6556 @}
6557@end group
6558@end smallexample
252b5132 6559
7542af2a
AM
6560both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6561address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6562@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6563section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6564
5c3049d2
AM
6565For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6566addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6567
6568@itemize @bullet
6569@item
c05f749e
AM
6570Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6571operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6572absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6573@item
7542af2a
AM
6574Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6575relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6576and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6577@item
c05f749e
AM
6578Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6579in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6580address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6581before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
6582@end itemize
6583
6584The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6585
6586@itemize @bullet
6587@item
6588An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6589@item
6590The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6591@item
9bc8bb33 6592The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 6593relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
6594(after above conversions) is also a number when
6595@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6596but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
6597@item
6598The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6599relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6600section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
6601@item
6602The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6603conversions) is an absolute address.
6604@end itemize
252b5132
RH
6605
6606You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6607to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6608create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6609section @samp{.data}:
6610@smallexample
6611SECTIONS
6612 @{
6613 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6614 @}
6615@end smallexample
6616@noindent
6617If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6618@samp{.data} section.
6619
7542af2a
AM
6620Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6621particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6622
252b5132
RH
6623@node Builtin Functions
6624@subsection Builtin Functions
6625@cindex functions in expressions
6626The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6627use in linker script expressions.
6628
6629@table @code
6630@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6631@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6632@cindex expression, absolute
6633Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6634of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6635value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6636normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6637
6638@item ADDR(@var{section})
6639@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6640@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 6641Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 6642script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
6643the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6644@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6645@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6646the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
6647@smallexample
6648@group
6649SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6650 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 6651 @{
252b5132
RH
6652 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6653 @dots{}
6654 @}
6655 .output :
6656 @{
6657 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6658 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6659 @}
6660@dots{} @}
6661@end group
6662@end smallexample
6663
876f4090
NS
6664@item ALIGN(@var{align})
6665@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6666@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6667@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
6668@cindex round up location counter
6669@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
6670@cindex round up expression
6671@cindex align expression
6672Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6673to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6674doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6675arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6676expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 6677equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
6678
6679Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6680next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6681variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6682input sections:
252b5132
RH
6683@smallexample
6684@group
6685SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6686 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6687 *(.data)
6688 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6689 @}
6690@dots{} @}
6691@end group
6692@end smallexample
6693@noindent
6694The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6695a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6696a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6697of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6698
6699The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6700
362c1d1a
NS
6701@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6702@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6703@cindex section alignment
6704Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6705been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6706evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6707the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6708value in that section.
6709@smallexample
6710@group
6711SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6712 .output @{
6713 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6714 @dots{}
6715 @}
6716@dots{} @}
6717@end group
6718@end smallexample
6719
252b5132
RH
6720@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6721@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6722This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6723scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6724section.
6725
2d20f7bf
JJ
6726@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6727@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6728This is equivalent to either
6729@smallexample
6730(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6731@end smallexample
6732or
6733@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
6734(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6735 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
6736@end smallexample
6737@noindent
6738depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6739for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6740@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6741If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6742memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6743bytes in the on-disk file.
6744
6745This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6746any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6747@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
6748be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6749running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6750that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6751page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
6752
6753@noindent
6754Example:
6755@smallexample
6756 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6757@end smallexample
6758
6759@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6760@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6761This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6762evaluation purposes.
6763
6764@smallexample
6765 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6766@end smallexample
6767
a4f5ad88
JJ
6768@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6769@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6770This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 6771@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6772When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6773does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
6774@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6775argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6776script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
6777@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6778padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6779section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6780
6781@smallexample
6782 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6783@end smallexample
6784
252b5132
RH
6785@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6786@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6787@cindex symbol defaults
6788Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
6789defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6790return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
6791default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6792shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6793the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6794existed, its value is preserved:
6795
6796@smallexample
6797@group
6798SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6799 .text : @{
6800 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6801 @dots{}
6802 @}
6803 @dots{}
6804@}
6805@end group
6806@end smallexample
6807
3ec57632
NC
6808@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6809@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6810Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6811
252b5132
RH
6812@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6813@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6814@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 6815Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
6816Section LMA}).
6817
2e53f7d6
NC
6818@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6819@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6820Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6821@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6822
252b5132
RH
6823@kindex MAX
6824@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6825Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6826
6827@kindex MIN
6828@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6829Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6830
6831@item NEXT(@var{exp})
6832@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
6833@cindex unallocated address, next
6834Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
6835This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
6836use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
6837output file, the two functions are equivalent.
6838
3ec57632
NC
6839@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6840@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6841Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6842
ba916c8a
MM
6843@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6844@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6845Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
6846value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
6847@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
6848will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
6849can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 6850``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
6851name.
6852
252b5132
RH
6853@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
6854@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
6855@cindex section size
6856Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6857been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6858evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6859@code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
6860@smallexample
6861@group
6862SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6863 .output @{
6864 .start = . ;
6865 @dots{}
6866 .end = . ;
6867 @}
6868 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
6869 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
6870@dots{} @}
6871@end group
6872@end smallexample
6873
6874@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
6875@itemx sizeof_headers
6876@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
6877@cindex header size
6878Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
6879information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
6880this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
6881choose, to facilitate paging.
6882
6883@cindex not enough room for program headers
6884@cindex program headers, not enough room
6885When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
6886@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
6887number of program headers before it has determined all the section
6888addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
6889additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
6890room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
6891the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
6892script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
6893you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
6894command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
6895@end table
6896
6897@node Implicit Linker Scripts
6898@section Implicit Linker Scripts
6899@cindex implicit linker scripts
6900If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
6901an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
6902linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
6903linker will report an error.
6904
6905An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
6906
6907Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
6908assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
6909commands.
6910
6911Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
6912at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
6913read. This can affect archive searching.
6914
6915@ifset GENERIC
6916@node Machine Dependent
6917@chapter Machine Dependent Features
6918
6919@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
6920@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
6921sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
6922functionality are not listed.
6923
6924@menu
36f63dca
NC
6925@ifset H8300
6926* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
6927@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
6928@ifset M68HC11
6929* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
6930@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
6931@ifset ARM
6932* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
6933@end ifset
6934@ifset HPPA
6935* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
6936@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
6937@ifset M68K
6938* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
6939@end ifset
833794fc
MR
6940@ifset MIPS
6941* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
6942@end ifset
3c3bdf30 6943@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 6944* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 6945@end ifset
2469cfa2 6946@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 6947* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 6948@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
6949@ifset NDS32
6950* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
6951@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
6952@ifset NIOSII
6953* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
6954@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
6955@ifset POWERPC
6956* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
6957@end ifset
6958@ifset POWERPC64
6959* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
6960@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
6961@ifset S/390
6962* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
6963@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
6964@ifset SPU
6965* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
6966@end ifset
74459f0e 6967@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 6968* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 6969@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
6970@ifset WIN32
6971* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
6972@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
6973@ifset XTENSA
6974* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
6975@end ifset
252b5132
RH
6976@end menu
6977@end ifset
6978
252b5132
RH
6979@ifset H8300
6980@ifclear GENERIC
6981@raisesections
6982@end ifclear
6983
6984@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 6985@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
6986
6987@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 6988For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
6989you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
6990
6991@table @emph
6992@cindex relaxing on H8/300
6993@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 6994@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
6995targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
6996program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
6997respectively.
6998
6999@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7000@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 7001@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 7002@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
7003sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7004page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7005(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7006@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7007top page of memory).
1502569c 7008
81f5558e
NC
7009@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7010indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7011displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7012the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7013@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7014whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7015range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7016
1502569c 7017@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 7018@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 7019biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 7020which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
7021page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7022(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 7023@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
7024the top page of memory).
7025
7026@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
7027@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
702832 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
7029changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7030(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 7031@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 7032the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
7033@end table
7034
7035@ifclear GENERIC
7036@lowersections
7037@end ifclear
7038@end ifset
7039
36f63dca 7040@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 7041@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 7042@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
7043@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7044@node Renesas
7045@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 7046
c2dcd04e
NC
7047@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7048H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7049options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7050@end ifset
7051@end ifclear
7052
36f63dca
NC
7053@ifset ARM
7054@ifclear GENERIC
7055@raisesections
7056@end ifclear
7057
93fd0973
SC
7058@ifset M68HC11
7059@ifclear GENERIC
7060@raisesections
7061@end ifclear
7062
7063@node M68HC11/68HC12
7064@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7065
7066@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7067
7068@subsection Linker Relaxation
7069
7070For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7071optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7072
7073@table @emph
7074@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7075@item relaxing address modes
7076@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7077targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7078program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7079respectively.
7080
7081@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7082transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7083page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7084
7085@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7086When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7087of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7088addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7089@code{bset} instructions.
7090
7091@end table
7092
7093@subsection Trampoline Generation
7094
7095@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7096@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7097For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7098call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7099will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7100trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7101case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7102point to the function trampoline.
7103
7104@ifclear GENERIC
7105@lowersections
7106@end ifclear
7107@end ifset
7108
36f63dca 7109@node ARM
3674e28a 7110@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7111
7112@cindex ARM interworking support
7113@kindex --support-old-code
7114For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7115between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7116been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7117line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7118libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7119option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7120given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7121which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7122the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7123non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7124
7125@cindex thumb entry point
7126@cindex entry point, thumb
7127@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7128The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7129@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7130But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7131branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7132executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7133
ce11ba6c
KT
7134@cindex PE import table prefixing
7135@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7136The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7137the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7138element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7139import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7140
e489d0ae
PB
7141@cindex BE8
7142@kindex --be8
7143The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7144executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7145objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7146option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7147little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7148
3674e28a
PB
7149@cindex TARGET1
7150@kindex --target1-rel
7151@kindex --target1-abs
7152The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7153@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7154or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7155and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7156
7157@cindex TARGET2
7158@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7159The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7160@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7161meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7162@table @samp
7163@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7164@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7165@item abs
7166@samp{R_ARM_ABS32} (arm*-*-symbianelf)
3674e28a
PB
7167@item got-rel
7168@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7169@end table
7170
319850b4
JB
7171@cindex FIX_V4BX
7172@kindex --fix-v4bx
7173The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7174specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7175interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7176also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7177
7178In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7179linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7180@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7181
7182In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7183relocations are ignored.
7184
845b51d6
PB
7185@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7186@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7187Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7188relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7189
7190@smallexample
7191TST rM, #1
7192MOVEQ PC, rM
7193BX Rn
7194@end smallexample
7195
7196This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7197and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7198condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7199
33bfe774
JB
7200@cindex USE_BLX
7201@kindex --use-blx
7202The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7203BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7204situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7205code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7206each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7207
7208This option is enabled implicitly for SymbianOS, so there is no need to
7209specify it if you are using that target.
7210
c6dd86c6
JB
7211@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7212@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7213The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7214bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7215instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7216to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7217the support code can read the intended values.
7218
7219The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7220intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7221and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7222intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7223full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7224you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7225
7226If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7227enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7228@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7229mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7230vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7231@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7232
7233If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7234potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7235such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7236first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7237instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7238the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7239are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7240
2de70689
MGD
7241@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7242@kindex --fix-arm1176
7243@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7244The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7245in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7246are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7247unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7248
9d5777a3 7249Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7250Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7251http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7252
a504d23a
LA
7253@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7254@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7255
7256The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7257workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7258the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7259off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7260the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7261core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7262integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7263VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7264
7265The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7266necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7267
7268The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7269@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7270STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7271linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7272@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7273
7274If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7275potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7276such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7277replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7278branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7279then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7280
7281The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7282the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7283
7284The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7285they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7286there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7287occurs.
7288
7289The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7290PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7291large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7292cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7293occurs.
7294
bf21ed78
MS
7295@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7296@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7297The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7298warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7299enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7300linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7301using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7302not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7303
7304@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7305@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7306The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7307warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7308@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7309linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7310using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7311
726150b7
NC
7312@cindex PIC_VENEER
7313@kindex --pic-veneer
7314The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7315ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7316is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7317@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7318
7319@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7320@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7321The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7322code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7323perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7324placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7325controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7326The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7327duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7328group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7329code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7330where they should be placed.
7331
7332The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7333@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7334placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7335branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7336placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7337value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7338exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7339A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7340linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7341from the input sections.
7342
7343The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7344@samp{N = +1}.
7345
1a51c1a4
NC
7346Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7347only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7348otherwise.
7349
1db37fe6
YG
7350@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7351@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7352@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7353The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7354
7355The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7356
68fcca92
JW
7357@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7358@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7359@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7360The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7361
7362Please contact ARM for further details.
7363
1db37fe6
YG
7364@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7365@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7366@cindex Merging exidx entries
7367The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7368
7369@kindex --long-plt
7370@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7371The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7372which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7373entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7374
1f56df9d
JW
7375@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7376@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7377The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7378link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7379
4ba2ef8f
TP
7380@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7381All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7382Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7383@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7384veneers in memory.
7385
54ddd295
TP
7386@kindex --cmse-implib
7387@cindex Secure gateway import library
7388The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7389specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7390secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7391executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7392
0955507f
TP
7393@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7394@cindex Input import library
7395The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7396must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7397given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7398in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7399@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7400library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7401library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7402for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7403specified.
7404
36f63dca
NC
7405@ifclear GENERIC
7406@lowersections
7407@end ifclear
7408@end ifset
7409
7410@ifset HPPA
7411@ifclear GENERIC
7412@raisesections
7413@end ifclear
7414
7415@node HPPA ELF32
7416@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7417@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7418@kindex --multi-subspace
7419When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7420import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7421The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7422stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7423multiple sub-spaces.
7424
7425@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7426@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7427Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7428stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7429@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7430sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7431a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7432the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7433conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7434prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7435A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7436branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7437@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7438@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7439detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7440positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7441
7442Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7443single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7444create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7445large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7446
7447@ifclear GENERIC
7448@lowersections
7449@end ifclear
7450@end ifset
7451
7fb9f789
NC
7452@ifset M68K
7453@ifclear GENERIC
7454@raisesections
7455@end ifclear
7456
7457@node M68K
7458@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7459
7460@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7461@kindex --got=@var{type}
7462The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7463The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7464@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7465the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7466@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7467entries only at non-negative offsets.
7468@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7469entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7470support such GOTs.
7471@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7472output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7473file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7474files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7475
7476@ifclear GENERIC
7477@lowersections
7478@end ifclear
7479@end ifset
7480
833794fc
MR
7481@ifset MIPS
7482@ifclear GENERIC
7483@raisesections
7484@end ifclear
7485
7486@node MIPS
7487@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7488
7489@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7490@kindex --insn32
7491@kindex --no-insn32
7492The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7493microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7494in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7495used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7496or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7497including 16-bit ones where possible.
7498
8b10b0b3
MR
7499@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7500@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7501@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7502The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7503control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7504@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7505relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7506calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7507relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7508instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7509or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7510the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7511
833794fc
MR
7512@ifclear GENERIC
7513@lowersections
7514@end ifclear
7515@end ifset
7516
36f63dca
NC
7517@ifset MMIX
7518@ifclear GENERIC
7519@raisesections
7520@end ifclear
7521
7522@node MMIX
7523@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7524For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7525@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7526understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7527can translate between the two formats.
7528
7529There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7530Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7531registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7532equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7533@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7534global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7535this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7536symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7537
7a2de473
HPN
7538Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7539@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7540The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7541of a section.
36f63dca
NC
7542
7543Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7544are left out from an mmo file.
7545
7546@ifclear GENERIC
7547@lowersections
7548@end ifclear
7549@end ifset
7550
7551@ifset MSP430
7552@ifclear GENERIC
7553@raisesections
7554@end ifclear
7555
7556@node MSP430
7557@section @code{ld} and MSP430
7558For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7559will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7560just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7561
7562@cindex MSP430 extra sections
7563The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7564
7565@table @code
7566@item @samp{.vectors}
7567Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7568
7569@item @samp{.bootloader}
7570Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7571in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7572
7573@item @samp{.infomem}
7574Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7575this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7576
c0065db7 7577@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
7578This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7579in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7580
7581@item @samp{.noinit}
7582Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7583
c0065db7 7584The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
7585@end table
7586
7ef3addb
JL
7587@table @option
7588@cindex MSP430 Options
7589@kindex --code-region
7590@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7591This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7592argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7593using this option.
7594
7595@kindex --data-region
7596@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7597This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7598[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7599for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7600
7601@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7602@item --disable-sec-transformation
7603Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7604and @code{--data-region} options.
7605This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7606wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7607not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7608@end table
7609
36f63dca
NC
7610@ifclear GENERIC
7611@lowersections
7612@end ifclear
7613@end ifset
7614
35c08157
KLC
7615@ifset NDS32
7616@ifclear GENERIC
7617@raisesections
7618@end ifclear
7619
7620@node NDS32
7621@section @code{ld} and NDS32
7622@kindex relaxing on NDS32
7623For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7624relaxes objects according to these options.
7625
7626@table @code
7627@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7628Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7629
7630@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7631Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7632
7633@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7634Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7635
7636@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7637Export the EX9 table after linking.
7638
7639@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7640Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7641
7642@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7643Update the existing EX9 table.
7644
7645@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7646Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7647
7648@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7649Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7650
7651@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7652Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7653
7654@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7655Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7656@end table
7657
7658@ifclear GENERIC
7659@lowersections
7660@end ifclear
7661@end ifset
7662
78058a5e
SL
7663@ifset NIOSII
7664@ifclear GENERIC
7665@raisesections
7666@end ifclear
7667
7668@node Nios II
7669@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7670@cindex Nios II call relaxation
7671@kindex --relax on Nios II
7672
7673Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7674transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7675which may result in @command{ld} giving
7676@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7677The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7678trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7679outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7680trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7681be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7682larger than 256MB.
7683
7684The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7685is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7686@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7687locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7688source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7689register as a temporary.
7690
7691Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7692relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7693option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7694
7695@ifclear GENERIC
7696@lowersections
7697@end ifclear
7698@end ifset
7699
2a60a7a8
AM
7700@ifset POWERPC
7701@ifclear GENERIC
7702@raisesections
7703@end ifclear
7704
7705@node PowerPC ELF32
7706@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7707@cindex PowerPC long branches
7708@kindex --relax on PowerPC
7709Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7710displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7711@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7712@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7713the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7714section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
7715section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7716@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7717both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7718considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
7719
7720@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7721@table @option
7722@cindex PowerPC PLT
7723@kindex --bss-plt
7724@item --bss-plt
7725Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7726generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7727the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7728writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7729@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7730PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7731compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7732BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7733
016687f8
AM
7734@kindex --secure-plt
7735@item --secure-plt
7736@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7737@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7738when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7739layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7740style BSS PLT.
7741
2a60a7a8
AM
7742@cindex PowerPC GOT
7743@kindex --sdata-got
7744@item --sdata-got
7745The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7746sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7747@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7748section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7749@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7750@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7751@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7752@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7753PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7754pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7755GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7756really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7757
7758@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7759@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7760@item --emit-stub-syms
7761This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7762symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7763
7764@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7765@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7766@item --no-tls-optimize
7767PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7768sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7769disable the optimization.
7770@end table
7771
7772@ifclear GENERIC
7773@lowersections
7774@end ifclear
7775@end ifset
7776
7777@ifset POWERPC64
7778@ifclear GENERIC
7779@raisesections
7780@end ifclear
7781
7782@node PowerPC64 ELF64
7783@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7784
7785@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
7786@table @option
7787@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
7788@kindex --stub-group-size
7789@item --stub-group-size
7790Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
7791by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7792@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7793sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7794a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7795the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7796conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7797prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7798A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7799branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7800@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7801@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7802detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7803positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7804
7805Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7806single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7807create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7808large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7809
7810@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
7811@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7812@item --emit-stub-syms
7813This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7814symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7815
7816@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
7817@kindex --dotsyms
7818@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
7819@item --dotsyms
7820@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
7821These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
7822in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
7823function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
7824code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
7825properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
7826to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
7827@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
7828dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
7829feature.
7830
7ae4ea7d
AM
7831@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
7832@kindex --save-restore-funcs
7833@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
7834@item --save-restore-funcs
7835@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
7836These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
7837provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
7838@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
7839function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
7840link.
7841
2a60a7a8
AM
7842@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
7843@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7844@item --no-tls-optimize
7845PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7846sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7847disable the optimization.
7848
7c9cf415
AM
7849@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
7850@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
7851@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
7852@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
7853@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
7854@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
7855@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 7856These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
7857stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
7858an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
7859@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
7860stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
7861generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
7862__tls_get_addr_opt.
7863Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
7864much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
7865an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
7866will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
7867@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
7868and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
7869this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
7870Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 7871@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 7872register saves.
7c9cf415 7873
2a60a7a8
AM
7874@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
7875@kindex --no-opd-optimize
7876@item --no-opd-optimize
7877PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
7878corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 7879the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
7880Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
7881
7882@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
7883@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
7884@item --non-overlapping-opd
7885Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
7886@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
7887the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
7888entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
7889
7890@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
7891@kindex --no-toc-optimize
7892@item --no-toc-optimize
7893PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
7894entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
7895reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
7896marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
7897marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
7898relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
7899unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
7900reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
7901discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
7902reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
7903code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
7904optimization.
7905
d882c988
AM
7906@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
7907@kindex --no-inline-optimize
7908@item --no-inline-optimize
7909PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
7910marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
7911@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
7912a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
7913locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
7914disables that optimization.
7915
2a60a7a8
AM
7916@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
7917@kindex --no-multi-toc
7918@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
7919If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
7920@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
7921where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
7922entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
7923total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
7924grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
7925TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
7926calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
7927help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
792864K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
7929Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
7930
7931@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
7932@kindex --no-toc-sort
7933@item --no-toc-sort
7934By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
7935happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
7936placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
7937with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
7938referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
7939@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
7940results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
7941off this feature.
7942
7943@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
7944@kindex --plt-align
7945@kindex --no-plt-align
7946@item --plt-align
7947@itemx --no-plt-align
7948Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
7949aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
7950boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
7951specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
7952specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
7953if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
7954PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
7955
7956@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
7957@kindex --plt-static-chain
7958@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
7959@item --plt-static-chain
7960@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
7961Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
7962chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
7963chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
7964
7965@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
7966@kindex --plt-thread-safe
7967@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
7968@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 7969@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
7970With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
7971lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
7972another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
7973order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
7974memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
7975barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
7976looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
7977seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
7978default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
7979
7980@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
7981@kindex --plt-localentry
7982@kindex --no-plt-localentry
7983@item --plt-localentry
7984@itemx --no-localentry
7985ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
7986ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
7987(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
7988Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
7989or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
7990functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
7991in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
7992interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
7993including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
7994to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
7995complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
7996care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
7997
7998@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
7999@kindex --power10-stubs
8000@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8001@item --power10-stubs
8002@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8003When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8004relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
8005linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8006for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8007power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
8008power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8009allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
8010@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8011auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
8012@end table
8013
8014@ifclear GENERIC
8015@lowersections
8016@end ifclear
8017@end ifset
8018
b4cbbe8f
AK
8019@ifset S/390
8020@ifclear GENERIC
8021@raisesections
8022@end ifclear
8023
8024@node S/390 ELF
8025@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8026
8027@cindex S/390 ELF options
8028@table @option
8029
8030@cindex S/390
8031@kindex --s390-pgste
8032@item --s390-pgste
8033This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8034segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8035binaries marked that way.
8036@end table
8037
8038@ifclear GENERIC
8039@lowersections
8040@end ifclear
8041@end ifset
8042
49fa1e15
AM
8043@ifset SPU
8044@ifclear GENERIC
8045@raisesections
8046@end ifclear
8047
8048@node SPU ELF
8049@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8050
8051@cindex SPU ELF options
8052@table @option
8053
8054@cindex SPU plugins
8055@kindex --plugin
8056@item --plugin
8057This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8058
8059@cindex SPU overlays
8060@kindex --no-overlays
8061@item --no-overlays
8062Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8063regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8064@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8065turns off all this special overlay handling.
8066
8067@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8068@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8069@item --emit-stub-syms
8070This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8071symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8072
8073@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8074@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8075@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8076This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8077function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8078on calls to non-overlay regions.
8079
8080@cindex SPU local store size
8081@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8082@item --local-store=lo:hi
8083@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8084the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8085range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8086
c0065db7 8087@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8088@kindex --stack-analysis
8089@item --stack-analysis
8090SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8091unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8092under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8093@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8094@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8095determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8096for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8097for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8098for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8099find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8100and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8101under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8102dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8103is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8104and calls will be given.
8105
c0065db7 8106@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8107@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8108@item --emit-stack-syms
8109This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8110in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8111These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8112functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8113functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8114such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8115The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8116@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8117@end table
8118
8119@ifclear GENERIC
8120@lowersections
8121@end ifclear
8122@end ifset
8123
36f63dca
NC
8124@ifset TICOFF
8125@ifclear GENERIC
8126@raisesections
8127@end ifclear
8128
8129@node TI COFF
8130@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8131@cindex TI COFF versions
8132@kindex --format=@var{version}
8133The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8134TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8135also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8136format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8137header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8138
8139@ifclear GENERIC
8140@lowersections
8141@end ifclear
8142@end ifset
8143
2ca22b03
NC
8144@ifset WIN32
8145@ifclear GENERIC
8146@raisesections
8147@end ifclear
8148
8149@node WIN32
8150@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8151
c0065db7 8152This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8153See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8154command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8155
8156@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8157@cindex import libraries
8158@item import libraries
69da35b5 8159The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8160libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8161regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8162archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8163support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8164@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8165
c0065db7
RM
8166@item exporting DLL symbols
8167@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8168The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8169
8170@table @emph
8171@item using auto-export functionality
8172@cindex using auto-export functionality
8173By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8174which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8175
0a5d968e
NC
8176@itemize
8177@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8178@item --exclude-symbols
8179@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8180@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8181@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8182@end itemize
8183
09e2aba4
DK
8184When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8185(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8186symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8187often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8188private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8189options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8190exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8191final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8192
8193If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8194command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8195if either of the following are true:
8196
8197@itemize
8198@item A DEF file is used.
8199@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8200@end itemize
dc8465bf 8201
c0065db7
RM
8202@item using a DEF file
8203@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8204Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8205an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8206exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8207name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8208command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8209
8210@example
8211gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8212@end example
8213
0a5d968e
NC
8214Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8215@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8216
dc8465bf
NC
8217Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8218
8219@example
4b5bd4e7 8220LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8221
8222EXPORTS
8223foo
8224bar
8225_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8226another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8227var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8228doo = foo == foo2
8229eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8230@end example
dc8465bf 8231
7fcab871 8232This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8233symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8234alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8235by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8236@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8237@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8238export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8239in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8240symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8241
6b31ad16
DS
8242The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8243name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8244the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8245
b45619c0
NC
8246When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8247library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8248@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8249executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8250
8251With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8252specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8253non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8254
8255If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8256or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8257filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8258
4b5bd4e7
DS
8259The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8260
8261@example
8262EXPORTS
8263 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8264 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8265 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8266@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8267
8268Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8269@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8270@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8271@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8272Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8273@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8274string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8275
8276The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8277
8278@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8279will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8280by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8281linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8282library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8283
8284@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8285The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8286the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8287@code{*_imp__foo}).
8288
8289@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8290well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8291read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8292variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8293the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8294extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8295application will behave unexpectedly.
8296
8297@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8298it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8299symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8300API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8301the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8302
4b5bd4e7
DS
8303See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8304other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8305
8306@cindex creating a DEF file
8307While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8308with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8309
8310@item Using decorations
8311@cindex Using decorations
8312Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8313itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8314declared as:
8315
8316@example
8317__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8318__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8319@end example
8320
8321All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8322any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8323this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8324the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8325
8326Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8327decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8328instead:
8329
8330@example
8331__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8332__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8333@end example
8334
c0065db7
RM
8335This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8336when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8337variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8338code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8339of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8340omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8341@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8342information.
c0065db7 8343@end table
dc8465bf 8344
2ca22b03
NC
8345@cindex automatic data imports
8346@item automatic data imports
8347The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8348by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8349compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8350issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8351code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8352c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8353initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8354decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8355platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8356command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8357The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8358suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8359trigger the feature's use.
8360
c0065db7 8361auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8362additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8363
c0065db7 8364"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8365documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8366
c0065db7
RM
8367The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8368occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8369One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8370below.
8371
8372@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8373For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8374object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8375offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8376field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8377in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8378without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8379The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8380references.
8381
c0065db7
RM
8382The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8383be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8384themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8385runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8386compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8387support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8388run without error on an older system.
8389
c0065db7
RM
8390@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8391enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8392
8393@cindex direct linking to a dll
8394@item direct linking to a dll
8395The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8396including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8397libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8398traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8399libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8400function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8401though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8402storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8403tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8404large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8405
c0065db7 8406Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8407@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8408of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8409perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8410select the dll instead of an import library.
8411
2ca22b03 8412
69da35b5
NC
8413For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8414to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8415
8416@example
45e948fe
NC
8417libxxx.dll.a
8418xxx.dll.a
8419libxxx.a
8420xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8421libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8422cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8423libxxx.dll
8424xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8425@end example
8426
69da35b5
NC
8427before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8428
c0065db7
RM
8429(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8430where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8431@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8432file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8433@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8434
c0065db7
RM
8435Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8436@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8437was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8438various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8439could coexist on the same machine.
8440
2ca22b03
NC
8441The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8442applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8443libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8444
8445@example
8446bin/
8447 cygxxx.dll
8448lib/
8449 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8450 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8451@end example
8452
c0065db7
RM
8453Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8454done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8455
84561. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8457@example
8458gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8459@end example
2ca22b03 8460
69da35b5
NC
8461However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8462(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8463@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8464not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8465
2ca22b03
NC
84662. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8467directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8468should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8469making the app/dll.
8470
8471@example
8472ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8473@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8474
8475Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8476
8477@example
8478gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8479@end example
69da35b5
NC
8480
8481This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8482perfectly legal
8483
8484@example
8485bin/
8486 cygxxx-5.dll
8487lib/
c0065db7 8488 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
8489@end example
8490
dc8465bf 8491Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
8492even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8493@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8494
8495Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 8496wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
8497
84981. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8499work with auto-imported data.
8500
dc8465bf
NC
85012. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8502import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8503symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8504for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8505possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 8506
45e948fe
NC
85073. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8508critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8509in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8510stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8511
69da35b5 8512So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
8513true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8514a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8515binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
8516massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8517requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8518will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 8519
c0065db7 8520@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 8521@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8522@item adding additional names
8523Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
8524A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8525exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8526when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 8527import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 8528
c0065db7 8529@example
dc8465bf
NC
8530LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8531
8532EXPORTS
c0065db7 8533foo
dc8465bf 8534_foo = foo
c0065db7 8535@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8536
8537The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8538
8539Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8540source code using the "weak" attribute:
8541
c0065db7
RM
8542@example
8543void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 8544void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 8545@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8546
8547See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8548symbols.
8549
8550@item renaming symbols
8551Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 8552kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
8553@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8554DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 8555created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 8556
c0065db7 8557@example
dc8465bf
NC
8558LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8559
8560EXPORTS
8561_foo = foo
c0065db7 8562@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8563
8564The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8565@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 8566@end table
dc8465bf 8567
0a5d968e 8568Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 8569unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 8570If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
8571@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8572that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8573@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8574renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8575to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8576the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8577In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 8578which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
8579
8580@cindex weak externals
8581@item weak externals
8582The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8583weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8584defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8585are three variants of weak externals:
8586@itemize
8587@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8588called lazy externals.
8589@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8590This form is not presently implemented.
8591@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8592implemented.
8593@end itemize
8594As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8595are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8596uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
8597
8598@cindex aligned common symbols
8599@item aligned common symbols
8600As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8601desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8602the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8603carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8604by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8605tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8606but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8607warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 8608
2ca22b03
NC
8609@end table
8610
8611@ifclear GENERIC
8612@lowersections
8613@end ifclear
8614@end ifset
8615
e0001a05
NC
8616@ifset XTENSA
8617@ifclear GENERIC
8618@raisesections
8619@end ifclear
8620
8621@node Xtensa
8622@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8623
8624@cindex Xtensa processors
8625The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8626@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8627specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8628keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8629example, with the command:
8630
8631@smallexample
8632SECTIONS
8633@{
8634 .text : @{
8635 *(.literal .text)
8636 @}
8637@}
8638@end smallexample
8639
8640@noindent
8641@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8642and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8643literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8644interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8645group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8646files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8647and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 8648
43cd72b9 8649@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 8650@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
8651Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8652provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8653is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8654literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8655will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8656location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8657the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8658unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8659@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8660range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8661
8662For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8663to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8664instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8665instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8666instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8667@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8668hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8669By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8670switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8671density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8672instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8673performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8674linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8675a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8676
8677The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8678control the linker:
8679
8680@cindex Xtensa options
8681@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
8682@item --size-opt
8683When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8684more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8685no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8686alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8687preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
8688
8689@item --abi-windowed
8690@itemx --abi-call0
8691Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8692PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8693because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8694conventions.
8695Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8696of the first input object.
8697A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8698or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 8699@end table
e0001a05
NC
8700
8701@ifclear GENERIC
8702@lowersections
8703@end ifclear
8704@end ifset
8705
252b5132
RH
8706@ifclear SingleFormat
8707@node BFD
8708@chapter BFD
8709
8710@cindex back end
8711@cindex object file management
8712@cindex object formats available
8713@kindex objdump -i
8714The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8715These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8716object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8717format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8718it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8719associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8720object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8721(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8722list all the formats available for your configuration.
8723
8724@cindex BFD requirements
8725@cindex requirements for BFD
8726As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8727several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8728BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8729formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8730been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8731BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8732may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8733
8734One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8735mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8736useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8737conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8738
8739@menu
8740* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8741@end menu
8742
8743@node BFD outline
36f63dca 8744@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
8745@cindex opening object files
8746@include bfdsumm.texi
8747@end ifclear
8748
8749@node Reporting Bugs
8750@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
8751@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8752@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 8753
ff5dcc92 8754Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
8755
8756Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8757it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 8758to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 8759work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 8760@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8761
8762In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8763information that enables us to fix the bug.
8764
8765@menu
8766* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8767* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8768@end menu
8769
8770@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 8771@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
8772@cindex bug criteria
8773
8774If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8775
8776@itemize @bullet
8777@cindex fatal signal
8778@cindex linker crash
8779@cindex crash of linker
8780@item
8781If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 8782@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
8783
8784@cindex error on valid input
8785@item
ff5dcc92 8786If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
8787
8788@cindex invalid input
8789@item
ff5dcc92 8790If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
8791may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
8792object files are correct.
8793
8794@item
8795If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 8796improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
8797@end itemize
8798
8799@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 8800@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 8801@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 8802@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
8803
8804A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 8805products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
8806recommend you contact that organization first.
8807
8808You can find contact information for many support companies and
8809individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
8810distribution.
8811
ad22bfe8 8812@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 8813Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
8814@value{BUGURL}.
8815@end ifset
252b5132
RH
8816
8817The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
8818@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
8819fact or leave it out, state it!
8820
8821Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
8822problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
8823assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
8824matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
8825the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
8826location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
8827were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
8828into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
8829specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 8830and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
8831
8832Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
8833the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
8834on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
8835
8836Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
8837bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
8838respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
8839You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
8840
8841To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
8842
8843@itemize @bullet
8844@item
ff5dcc92 8845The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
8846the @samp{--version} argument.
8847
8848Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 8849the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8850
8851@item
ff5dcc92 8852Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
8853patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
8854
8855@item
8856The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
8857version number.
8858
8859@item
ff5dcc92 8860What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
8861``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
8862
8863@item
8864The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
8865observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
8866list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
8867sufficient.
8868
8869If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
8870and then we might not encounter the bug.
8871
8872@item
8873A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
8874bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
8875provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
8876bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
8877state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
8878requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
8879we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
8880attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
8881
8882If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
8883@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
8884object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
8885@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
8886how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
8887
8888@item
8889A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
8890incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
8891
ff5dcc92 8892Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
8893will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
8894not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
8895a chance to make a mistake.
8896
8897Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
8898say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 8899copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
8900C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
8901and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
8902fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
8903you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
8904any conclusion from our observations.
8905
8906@item
ff5dcc92 8907If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
8908diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
8909@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 8910If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
8911context, not by line number.
8912
8913The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
8914sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
8915@end itemize
8916
8917Here are some things that are not necessary:
8918
8919@itemize @bullet
8920@item
8921A description of the envelope of the bug.
8922
8923Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
8924which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
8925changes will not affect it.
8926
8927This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
8928will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
8929with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
8930We recommend that you save your time for something else.
8931
8932Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
8933of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
8934output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
8935less time, and so on.
8936
8937However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
8938report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
8939
8940@item
8941A patch for the bug.
8942
8943A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
8944the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
8945a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
8946to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
8947
ff5dcc92 8948Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
8949construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
8950through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
8951able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
8952fixed.
8953
8954And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
8955patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
8956help us to understand.
8957
8958@item
8959A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
8960
8961Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
8962things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
8963@end itemize
8964
8965@node MRI
8966@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
8967@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
8968To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
8969linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
8970alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
8971described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
8972simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 8973@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
8974linker commands; these commands are described here.
8975
8976In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
8977file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
8978features to make use of them.
8979
8980You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
8981@samp{-c} command-line option.
8982
8983Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
8984command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
8985blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 8986MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
8987issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
8988
8989Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
8990
8991You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
8992lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
8993The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
8994
8995@table @code
8996@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
8997@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
8998@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 8999Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
9000the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9001@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9002your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9003script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9004commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9005input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9006@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9007
9008@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9009@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9010Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9011in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9012
9013@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9014
9015@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9016@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9017Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9018@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9019
9020@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9021@item BASE @var{expression}
9022Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9023absolute addresses) in the output file.
9024
9025@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9026@item CHIP @var{expression}
9027@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9028This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9029
9030@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9031@item END
9032This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9033
9034@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9035@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9036Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 9037language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
9038
9039@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9040@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9041Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 9042@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
9043
9044The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9045same line, with no change in its effect.
9046
9047@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9048@item LOAD @var{filename}
9049@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9050Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9051same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9052command line.
9053
9054@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9055@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9056@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9057MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9058option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9059
9060@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9061@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9062@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9063Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9064order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9065script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9066sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9067file, in the order specified.
9068
9069@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9070@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9071@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9072@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9073Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9074@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9075
9076@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9077@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9078@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9079@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9080You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9081specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9082If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9083@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9084@end table
9085
793c5807
NC
9086@node GNU Free Documentation License
9087@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9088@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9089
370b66a1
CD
9090@node LD Index
9091@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9092
9093@printindex cp
9094
9095@tex
7ca01ed9 9096% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9097% meantime:
9098\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9099\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9100\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9101\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9102\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9103\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9104\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9105\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9106\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9107% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9108@end tex
9109
252b5132 9110@bye